Mercurial > hg > sv-dependency-builds
comparison src/fftw-3.3.3/doc/texinfo.tex @ 10:37bf6b4a2645
Add FFTW3
author | Chris Cannam |
---|---|
date | Wed, 20 Mar 2013 15:35:50 +0000 |
parents | |
children |
comparison
equal
deleted
inserted
replaced
9:c0fb53affa76 | 10:37bf6b4a2645 |
---|---|
1 % texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files. | |
2 % | |
3 % Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex. | |
4 \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi | |
5 % | |
6 \def\texinfoversion{2012-03-11.15} | |
7 % | |
8 % Copyright 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, | |
9 % 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, | |
10 % 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc. | |
11 % | |
12 % This texinfo.tex file is free software: you can redistribute it and/or | |
13 % modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as | |
14 % published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the | |
15 % License, or (at your option) any later version. | |
16 % | |
17 % This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be | |
18 % useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty | |
19 % of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU | |
20 % General Public License for more details. | |
21 % | |
22 % You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License | |
23 % along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. | |
24 % | |
25 % As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing | |
26 % a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without | |
27 % restriction. (This has been our intent since Texinfo was invented.) | |
28 % | |
29 % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug | |
30 % reports; you can get the latest version from: | |
31 % http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page), or | |
32 % ftp://tug.org/tex/texinfo.tex | |
33 % (and all CTAN mirrors, see http://www.ctan.org). | |
34 % The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out | |
35 % of date, so if that's what you're using, please check. | |
36 % | |
37 % Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a | |
38 % complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the | |
39 % problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated. | |
40 % | |
41 % To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the | |
42 % texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple | |
43 % manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this: | |
44 % tex foo.texi | |
45 % texindex foo.?? | |
46 % tex foo.texi | |
47 % tex foo.texi | |
48 % dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps. | |
49 % The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct. | |
50 % Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more | |
51 % than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary. | |
52 % | |
53 % It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some | |
54 % extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the | |
55 % full Texinfo distribution. | |
56 % | |
57 % The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo. | |
58 | |
59 | |
60 \message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:} | |
61 | |
62 % If in a .fmt file, print the version number | |
63 % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because | |
64 % they might have appeared in the input file name. | |
65 \everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}% | |
66 \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active} | |
67 | |
68 \chardef\other=12 | |
69 | |
70 % We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo. | |
71 % For @tex, we can use \tabalign. | |
72 \let\+ = \relax | |
73 | |
74 % Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine. | |
75 \let\ptexb=\b | |
76 \let\ptexbullet=\bullet | |
77 \let\ptexc=\c | |
78 \let\ptexcomma=\, | |
79 \let\ptexdot=\. | |
80 \let\ptexdots=\dots | |
81 \let\ptexend=\end | |
82 \let\ptexequiv=\equiv | |
83 \let\ptexexclam=\! | |
84 \let\ptexfootnote=\footnote | |
85 \let\ptexgtr=> | |
86 \let\ptexhat=^ | |
87 \let\ptexi=\i | |
88 \let\ptexindent=\indent | |
89 \let\ptexinsert=\insert | |
90 \let\ptexlbrace=\{ | |
91 \let\ptexless=< | |
92 \let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite | |
93 \let\ptexnoindent=\noindent | |
94 \let\ptexplus=+ | |
95 \let\ptexraggedright=\raggedright | |
96 \let\ptexrbrace=\} | |
97 \let\ptexslash=\/ | |
98 \let\ptexstar=\* | |
99 \let\ptext=\t | |
100 \let\ptextop=\top | |
101 {\catcode`\'=\active \global\let\ptexquoteright'}% active in plain's math mode | |
102 | |
103 % If this character appears in an error message or help string, it | |
104 % starts a new line in the output. | |
105 \newlinechar = `^^J | |
106 | |
107 % Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error | |
108 % messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. | |
109 % | |
110 \ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined | |
111 \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0. | |
112 \else | |
113 \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space} | |
114 \fi | |
115 | |
116 % Set up fixed words for English if not already set. | |
117 \ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi | |
118 \ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi | |
119 \ifx\putworderror\undefined \gdef\putworderror{error}\fi | |
120 \ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi | |
121 \ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi | |
122 \ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi | |
123 \ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi | |
124 \ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi | |
125 \ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi | |
126 \ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi | |
127 \ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi | |
128 \ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi | |
129 \ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi | |
130 \ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi | |
131 \ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi | |
132 \ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi | |
133 \ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi | |
134 \ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi | |
135 \ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi | |
136 \ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi | |
137 % | |
138 \ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi | |
139 \ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi | |
140 \ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi | |
141 \ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi | |
142 \ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi | |
143 \ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi | |
144 \ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi | |
145 \ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi | |
146 \ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi | |
147 \ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi | |
148 \ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi | |
149 \ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi | |
150 % | |
151 \ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi | |
152 \ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi | |
153 \ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi | |
154 \ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi | |
155 \ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi | |
156 | |
157 % Since the category of space is not known, we have to be careful. | |
158 \chardef\spacecat = 10 | |
159 \def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =\spacecat} | |
160 | |
161 % sometimes characters are active, so we need control sequences. | |
162 \chardef\ampChar = `\& | |
163 \chardef\colonChar = `\: | |
164 \chardef\commaChar = `\, | |
165 \chardef\dashChar = `\- | |
166 \chardef\dotChar = `\. | |
167 \chardef\exclamChar= `\! | |
168 \chardef\hashChar = `\# | |
169 \chardef\lquoteChar= `\` | |
170 \chardef\questChar = `\? | |
171 \chardef\rquoteChar= `\' | |
172 \chardef\semiChar = `\; | |
173 \chardef\slashChar = `\/ | |
174 \chardef\underChar = `\_ | |
175 | |
176 % Ignore a token. | |
177 % | |
178 \def\gobble#1{} | |
179 | |
180 % The following is used inside several \edef's. | |
181 \def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname} | |
182 | |
183 % Hyphenation fixes. | |
184 \hyphenation{ | |
185 Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script | |
186 ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps | |
187 data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script | |
188 man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm | |
189 par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces | |
190 spell-ing spell-ings | |
191 stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space | |
192 wide-spread wrap-around | |
193 } | |
194 | |
195 % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages. | |
196 \newdimen\bindingoffset | |
197 \newdimen\normaloffset | |
198 \newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight | |
199 | |
200 % For a final copy, take out the rectangles | |
201 % that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided | |
202 % that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin). | |
203 % | |
204 \def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt } | |
205 | |
206 % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file | |
207 % and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here, | |
208 % since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make | |
209 % some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log | |
210 % file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX. | |
211 % | |
212 \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}% | |
213 \def\loggingall{% | |
214 \tracingstats2 | |
215 \tracingpages1 | |
216 \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex | |
217 \tracingparagraphs1 | |
218 \tracingoutput1 | |
219 \tracingmacros2 | |
220 \tracingrestores1 | |
221 \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen | |
222 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined\else % etex gives us more logging | |
223 \tracingscantokens1 | |
224 \tracingifs1 | |
225 \tracinggroups1 | |
226 \tracingnesting2 | |
227 \tracingassigns1 | |
228 \fi | |
229 \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex | |
230 \errorcontextlines16 | |
231 }% | |
232 | |
233 % @errormsg{MSG}. Do the index-like expansions on MSG, but if things | |
234 % aren't perfect, it's not the end of the world, being an error message, | |
235 % after all. | |
236 % | |
237 \def\errormsg{\begingroup \indexnofonts \doerrormsg} | |
238 \def\doerrormsg#1{\errmessage{#1}} | |
239 | |
240 % add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing | |
241 % we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space. | |
242 % | |
243 \def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount | |
244 \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi} | |
245 \def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount | |
246 \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi} | |
247 \def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount | |
248 \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi} | |
249 | |
250 % Do @cropmarks to get crop marks. | |
251 % | |
252 \newif\ifcropmarks | |
253 \let\cropmarks = \cropmarkstrue | |
254 % | |
255 % Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners. | |
256 % Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986 | |
257 % | |
258 \newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines | |
259 \newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=1pc | |
260 \newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt | |
261 \newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in | |
262 | |
263 % Output a mark which sets \thischapter, \thissection and \thiscolor. | |
264 % We dump everything together because we only have one kind of mark. | |
265 % This works because we only use \botmark / \topmark, not \firstmark. | |
266 % | |
267 % A mark contains a subexpression of the \ifcase ... \fi construct. | |
268 % \get*marks macros below extract the needed part using \ifcase. | |
269 % | |
270 % Another complication is to let the user choose whether \thischapter | |
271 % (\thissection) refers to the chapter (section) in effect at the top | |
272 % of a page, or that at the bottom of a page. The solution is | |
273 % described on page 260 of The TeXbook. It involves outputting two | |
274 % marks for the sectioning macros, one before the section break, and | |
275 % one after. I won't pretend I can describe this better than DEK... | |
276 \def\domark{% | |
277 \toks0=\expandafter{\lastchapterdefs}% | |
278 \toks2=\expandafter{\lastsectiondefs}% | |
279 \toks4=\expandafter{\prevchapterdefs}% | |
280 \toks6=\expandafter{\prevsectiondefs}% | |
281 \toks8=\expandafter{\lastcolordefs}% | |
282 \mark{% | |
283 \the\toks0 \the\toks2 | |
284 \noexpand\or \the\toks4 \the\toks6 | |
285 \noexpand\else \the\toks8 | |
286 }% | |
287 } | |
288 % \topmark doesn't work for the very first chapter (after the title | |
289 % page or the contents), so we use \firstmark there -- this gets us | |
290 % the mark with the chapter defs, unless the user sneaks in, e.g., | |
291 % @setcolor (or @url, or @link, etc.) between @contents and the very | |
292 % first @chapter. | |
293 \def\gettopheadingmarks{% | |
294 \ifcase0\topmark\fi | |
295 \ifx\thischapter\empty \ifcase0\firstmark\fi \fi | |
296 } | |
297 \def\getbottomheadingmarks{\ifcase1\botmark\fi} | |
298 \def\getcolormarks{\ifcase2\topmark\fi} | |
299 | |
300 % Avoid "undefined control sequence" errors. | |
301 \def\lastchapterdefs{} | |
302 \def\lastsectiondefs{} | |
303 \def\prevchapterdefs{} | |
304 \def\prevsectiondefs{} | |
305 \def\lastcolordefs{} | |
306 | |
307 % Main output routine. | |
308 \chardef\PAGE = 255 | |
309 \output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}} | |
310 | |
311 \newbox\headlinebox | |
312 \newbox\footlinebox | |
313 | |
314 % \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents | |
315 % does insertions, but you have to call it yourself. | |
316 \def\onepageout#1{% | |
317 \ifcropmarks \hoffset=0pt \else \hoffset=\normaloffset \fi | |
318 % | |
319 \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset | |
320 \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi | |
321 % | |
322 % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in | |
323 % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code). | |
324 \ifodd\pageno \getoddheadingmarks \else \getevenheadingmarks \fi | |
325 \setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline}% | |
326 \ifodd\pageno \getoddfootingmarks \else \getevenfootingmarks \fi | |
327 \setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}% | |
328 % | |
329 {% | |
330 % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to | |
331 % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends | |
332 % before the \shipout runs. | |
333 % | |
334 \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output. | |
335 \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if | |
336 % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example. | |
337 % We don't want .vr (or whatever) entries like this: | |
338 % \entry{{\tt \indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}} | |
339 % "\acronym" won't work when it's read back in; | |
340 % it needs to be | |
341 % {\code {{\tt \backslashcurfont }acronym} | |
342 \shipout\vbox{% | |
343 % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page. | |
344 \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi | |
345 % | |
346 \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup | |
347 \hsize = \outerhsize | |
348 \vskip-\topandbottommargin | |
349 \vtop to0pt{% | |
350 \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}% | |
351 \nointerlineskip | |
352 \line{% | |
353 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}% | |
354 \hfill | |
355 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}% | |
356 }% | |
357 \vss}% | |
358 \vskip\topandbottommargin | |
359 \line\bgroup | |
360 \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize. | |
361 \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi | |
362 \vbox\bgroup | |
363 \fi | |
364 % | |
365 \unvbox\headlinebox | |
366 \pagebody{#1}% | |
367 \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt | |
368 % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty. | |
369 % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingyyy.) | |
370 % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect. | |
371 \vskip 24pt | |
372 \unvbox\footlinebox | |
373 \fi | |
374 % | |
375 \ifcropmarks | |
376 \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup | |
377 \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup | |
378 \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill | |
379 \boxmaxdepth = \cornerthick | |
380 \vbox to0pt{\vss | |
381 \line{% | |
382 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}% | |
383 \hfill | |
384 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}% | |
385 }% | |
386 \nointerlineskip | |
387 \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}% | |
388 }% | |
389 \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause | |
390 \fi | |
391 }% end of \shipout\vbox | |
392 }% end of group with \indexdummies | |
393 \advancepageno | |
394 \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi | |
395 } | |
396 | |
397 \newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen | |
398 | |
399 \def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}} | |
400 {\catcode`\@ =11 | |
401 \gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi | |
402 % marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala) | |
403 \ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present | |
404 \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi | |
405 \dimen@=\dp#1\relax \unvbox#1\relax | |
406 \ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi | |
407 \ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi} | |
408 } | |
409 | |
410 % Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are | |
411 % offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize | |
412 % (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986) | |
413 % | |
414 \def\ewtop{\vrule height\cornerthick depth0pt width\cornerlong} | |
415 \def\nstop{\vbox | |
416 {\hrule height\cornerthick depth\cornerlong width\cornerthick}} | |
417 \def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth\cornerthick width\cornerlong} | |
418 \def\nsbot{\vbox | |
419 {\hrule height\cornerlong depth\cornerthick width\cornerthick}} | |
420 | |
421 % Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of | |
422 % the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a | |
423 % macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument. | |
424 % | |
425 \def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}} | |
426 \def\parseargusing#1#2{% | |
427 \def\argtorun{#2}% | |
428 \begingroup | |
429 \obeylines | |
430 \spaceisspace | |
431 #1% | |
432 \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below. | |
433 } | |
434 | |
435 {\obeylines % | |
436 \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{% | |
437 \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg. | |
438 \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm% | |
439 }% | |
440 } | |
441 | |
442 % First remove any @comment, then any @c comment. | |
443 \def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm} | |
444 \def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm} | |
445 | |
446 % Each occurrence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space. | |
447 % | |
448 % \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g., | |
449 % @end itemize @c foo | |
450 % This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed | |
451 % by \finishparsearg. | |
452 % | |
453 \def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M} | |
454 \def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M} | |
455 \def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{% | |
456 \def\temp{#3}% | |
457 \ifx\temp\empty | |
458 % Do not use \next, perhaps the caller of \parsearg uses it; reuse \temp: | |
459 \let\temp\finishparsearg | |
460 \else | |
461 \let\temp\argcheckspaces | |
462 \fi | |
463 % Put the space token in: | |
464 \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm | |
465 } | |
466 | |
467 % If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so | |
468 % to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation. | |
469 % We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now, | |
470 % just before passing the control to \argtorun. | |
471 % (Similarly, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is | |
472 % either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger | |
473 % that a pair of braces would be stripped. | |
474 % | |
475 % But first, we have to remove the trailing space token. | |
476 % | |
477 \def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}} | |
478 | |
479 % \parseargdef\foo{...} | |
480 % is roughly equivalent to | |
481 % \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo} | |
482 % \def\Xfoo#1{...} | |
483 % | |
484 % Actually, I use \csname\string\foo\endcsname, ie. \\foo, as it is my | |
485 % favourite TeX trick. --kasal, 16nov03 | |
486 | |
487 \def\parseargdef#1{% | |
488 \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1% | |
489 } | |
490 \def\doparseargdef#1#2{% | |
491 \def#2{\parsearg#1}% | |
492 \def#1##1% | |
493 } | |
494 | |
495 % Several utility definitions with active space: | |
496 { | |
497 \obeyspaces | |
498 \gdef\obeyedspace{ } | |
499 | |
500 % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword | |
501 % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this | |
502 % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input | |
503 % should produce a line of output anyway. | |
504 % | |
505 \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie} | |
506 | |
507 % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces | |
508 % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the | |
509 % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ). | |
510 \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space} | |
511 } | |
512 | |
513 | |
514 \def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next} | |
515 | |
516 % Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this: | |
517 % | |
518 % \envdef\foo{...} | |
519 % \def\Efoo{...} | |
520 % | |
521 % It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the | |
522 % actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also | |
523 % defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks | |
524 % whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be | |
525 % used to check whether the current environment is the one expected. | |
526 % | |
527 % Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they | |
528 % are not treated as environments; they don't open a group. (The | |
529 % implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this | |
530 % special case.) | |
531 | |
532 | |
533 % At run-time, environments start with this: | |
534 \def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}} | |
535 % initialize | |
536 \let\thisenv\empty | |
537 | |
538 % ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'': | |
539 \long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}} | |
540 \def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}} | |
541 | |
542 % Check whether we're in the right environment: | |
543 \def\checkenv#1{% | |
544 \def\temp{#1}% | |
545 \ifx\thisenv\temp | |
546 \else | |
547 \badenverr | |
548 \fi | |
549 } | |
550 | |
551 % Environment mismatch, #1 expected: | |
552 \def\badenverr{% | |
553 \errhelp = \EMsimple | |
554 \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp, | |
555 not \inenvironment\thisenv}% | |
556 } | |
557 \def\inenvironment#1{% | |
558 \ifx#1\empty | |
559 outside of any environment% | |
560 \else | |
561 in environment \expandafter\string#1% | |
562 \fi | |
563 } | |
564 | |
565 % @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo. | |
566 % But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv | |
567 % | |
568 \parseargdef\end{% | |
569 \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname | |
570 \else | |
571 % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal. | |
572 \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname | |
573 \csname E#1\endcsname | |
574 \endgroup | |
575 \fi | |
576 } | |
577 | |
578 \newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.} | |
579 | |
580 | |
581 % Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space | |
582 % equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space | |
583 % at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and | |
584 % since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the | |
585 % penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph. | |
586 {\catcode`@ = 11 | |
587 % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble | |
588 % if the definition is written into an index file. | |
589 \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M | |
590 \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ } | |
591 } | |
592 | |
593 % @: forces normal size whitespace following. | |
594 \def\:{\spacefactor=1000 } | |
595 | |
596 % @* forces a line break. | |
597 \def\*{\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces} | |
598 | |
599 % @/ allows a line break. | |
600 \let\/=\allowbreak | |
601 | |
602 % @. is an end-of-sentence period. | |
603 \def\.{.\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space} | |
604 | |
605 % @! is an end-of-sentence bang. | |
606 \def\!{!\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space} | |
607 | |
608 % @? is an end-of-sentence query. | |
609 \def\?{?\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space} | |
610 | |
611 % @frenchspacing on|off says whether to put extra space after punctuation. | |
612 % | |
613 \def\onword{on} | |
614 \def\offword{off} | |
615 % | |
616 \parseargdef\frenchspacing{% | |
617 \def\temp{#1}% | |
618 \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing | |
619 \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing | |
620 \else | |
621 \errhelp = \EMsimple | |
622 \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `\temp', must be on|off}% | |
623 \fi\fi | |
624 } | |
625 | |
626 % @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the | |
627 % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would | |
628 % produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph. | |
629 \def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}} | |
630 | |
631 % @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing | |
632 % it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box | |
633 % to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for | |
634 % \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is | |
635 % max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large, | |
636 % therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and | |
637 % the text is small, which looks bad. | |
638 % | |
639 % Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can | |
640 % cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it | |
641 % does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an | |
642 % explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The | |
643 % threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit | |
644 % percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex). | |
645 % | |
646 \newbox\groupbox | |
647 \def\vfilllimit{0.7} | |
648 % | |
649 \envdef\group{% | |
650 \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else | |
651 \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp | |
652 \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}% | |
653 \fi | |
654 \startsavinginserts | |
655 % | |
656 \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup | |
657 % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as | |
658 % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an | |
659 % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after | |
660 % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group | |
661 % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo | |
662 % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text. | |
663 \comment | |
664 } | |
665 % | |
666 % The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts | |
667 % \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done) | |
668 % \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space | |
669 % above. But it's pretty close. | |
670 \def\Egroup{% | |
671 % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group | |
672 % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth. | |
673 \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar. | |
674 \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth | |
675 \egroup % End the \vtop. | |
676 % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box. | |
677 \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox | |
678 % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less). | |
679 \dimen2 = \pageheight \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal | |
680 % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big | |
681 % group, force a page break. | |
682 \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2 | |
683 \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\pageheight | |
684 \page | |
685 \fi | |
686 \fi | |
687 \box\groupbox | |
688 \prevdepth = \dimen1 | |
689 \checkinserts | |
690 } | |
691 % | |
692 % TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help | |
693 % message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'. | |
694 % | |
695 \newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{% | |
696 group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J% | |
697 where each line of input produces a line of output.} | |
698 | |
699 % @need space-in-mils | |
700 % forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining. | |
701 | |
702 \newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in | |
703 | |
704 \parseargdef\need{% | |
705 % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a | |
706 % paragraph. | |
707 \par | |
708 % | |
709 % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless. | |
710 \dimen0 = #1\mil | |
711 \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox | |
712 \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox | |
713 \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2 | |
714 % | |
715 % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the | |
716 % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line. | |
717 % And a page break here is fine. | |
718 \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}% | |
719 % | |
720 % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the | |
721 % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the | |
722 % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider | |
723 % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the | |
724 % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999. | |
725 % | |
726 % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the | |
727 % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in | |
728 % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which | |
729 % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing | |
730 % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an | |
731 % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real | |
732 % document, then we can reconsider our strategy. | |
733 \penalty9999 | |
734 % | |
735 % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not. | |
736 \kern -#1\mil | |
737 % | |
738 % Do not allow a page break right after this kern. | |
739 \nobreak | |
740 \fi | |
741 } | |
742 | |
743 % @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented). | |
744 | |
745 \let\br = \par | |
746 | |
747 % @page forces the start of a new page. | |
748 % | |
749 \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject} | |
750 | |
751 % @exdent text.... | |
752 % outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin | |
753 | |
754 % This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment. | |
755 % That's how much \exdent should take out. | |
756 \newskip\exdentamount | |
757 | |
758 % This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun. | |
759 \parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break} | |
760 | |
761 % This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example. | |
762 \parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount | |
763 \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}} | |
764 | |
765 % @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current | |
766 % paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion | |
767 % class. WHICH is `l' or `r'. Not documented, written for gawk manual. | |
768 % | |
769 \newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm | |
770 \def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox} | |
771 % | |
772 \def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{% | |
773 \nobreak | |
774 \kern-\strutdepth | |
775 \vtop to \strutdepth{% | |
776 \baselineskip=\strutdepth | |
777 \vss | |
778 % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to | |
779 % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size. | |
780 \ifx#1l% | |
781 \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}% | |
782 \else | |
783 \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}% | |
784 \fi | |
785 \null | |
786 }% | |
787 }} | |
788 \def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l} | |
789 \def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r} | |
790 % | |
791 % @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]} | |
792 % (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right; | |
793 % else use TEXT for both). | |
794 % | |
795 \def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish} | |
796 \def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing. | |
797 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% | |
798 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt | |
799 \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts | |
800 \def\righttext{#2}% | |
801 \else | |
802 \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text | |
803 \def\righttext{#1}% | |
804 \fi | |
805 % | |
806 \ifodd\pageno | |
807 \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin | |
808 \else | |
809 \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}% | |
810 \fi | |
811 \temp | |
812 } | |
813 | |
814 % @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should | |
815 % surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the | |
816 % change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would | |
817 % have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main | |
818 % vertical list for the beginning and end of each change). This command | |
819 % is not documented, not supported, and doesn't work. | |
820 % | |
821 \def\|{% | |
822 % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode. | |
823 \leavevmode | |
824 % | |
825 % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output. | |
826 \vadjust{% | |
827 % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current | |
828 % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record. | |
829 \vskip-\baselineskip | |
830 % | |
831 % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So | |
832 % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin. | |
833 \llap{% | |
834 % | |
835 % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'. | |
836 \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt | |
837 % | |
838 % This is the space between the bar and the text. | |
839 \hskip 12pt | |
840 }% | |
841 }% | |
842 } | |
843 | |
844 % @include FILE -- \input text of FILE. | |
845 % | |
846 \def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz} | |
847 \def\includezzz#1{% | |
848 \pushthisfilestack | |
849 \def\thisfile{#1}% | |
850 {% | |
851 \makevalueexpandable % we want to expand any @value in FILE. | |
852 \turnoffactive % and allow special characters in the expansion | |
853 \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names. | |
854 \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @include of #1^^J}% | |
855 \edef\temp{\noexpand\input #1 }% | |
856 % | |
857 % This trickery is to read FILE outside of a group, in case it makes | |
858 % definitions, etc. | |
859 \expandafter | |
860 }\temp | |
861 \popthisfilestack | |
862 } | |
863 \def\filenamecatcodes{% | |
864 \catcode`\\=\other | |
865 \catcode`~=\other | |
866 \catcode`^=\other | |
867 \catcode`_=\other | |
868 \catcode`|=\other | |
869 \catcode`<=\other | |
870 \catcode`>=\other | |
871 \catcode`+=\other | |
872 \catcode`-=\other | |
873 \catcode`\`=\other | |
874 \catcode`\'=\other | |
875 } | |
876 | |
877 \def\pushthisfilestack{% | |
878 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm | |
879 } | |
880 \def\pushthisfilestackX{% | |
881 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm | |
882 } | |
883 \def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {% | |
884 \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}% | |
885 } | |
886 | |
887 \def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty} | |
888 \def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error: | |
889 the stack of filenames is empty.}} | |
890 % | |
891 \def\thisfile{} | |
892 | |
893 % @center line | |
894 % outputs that line, centered. | |
895 % | |
896 \parseargdef\center{% | |
897 \ifhmode | |
898 \let\centersub\centerH | |
899 \else | |
900 \let\centersub\centerV | |
901 \fi | |
902 \centersub{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}% | |
903 \let\centersub\relax % don't let the definition persist, just in case | |
904 } | |
905 \def\centerH#1{{% | |
906 \hfil\break | |
907 \advance\hsize by -\leftskip | |
908 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip | |
909 \line{#1}% | |
910 \break | |
911 }} | |
912 % | |
913 \newcount\centerpenalty | |
914 \def\centerV#1{% | |
915 % The idea here is the same as in \startdefun, \cartouche, etc.: if | |
916 % @center is the first thing after a section heading, we need to wipe | |
917 % out the negative parskip inserted by \sectionheading, but still | |
918 % prevent a page break here. | |
919 \centerpenalty = \lastpenalty | |
920 \ifnum\centerpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \fi | |
921 \ifnum\centerpenalty>9999 \penalty\centerpenalty \fi | |
922 \line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}% | |
923 } | |
924 | |
925 % @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space | |
926 % | |
927 \parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip} | |
928 | |
929 % @comment ...line which is ignored... | |
930 % @c is the same as @comment | |
931 % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment | |
932 % | |
933 \def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\other% | |
934 \catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other% | |
935 \commentxxx} | |
936 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}} | |
937 % | |
938 \let\c=\comment | |
939 | |
940 % @paragraphindent NCHARS | |
941 % We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough. | |
942 % NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'. | |
943 % We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though. | |
944 % | |
945 \def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords | |
946 \def\noneword{none} | |
947 % | |
948 \parseargdef\paragraphindent{% | |
949 \def\temp{#1}% | |
950 \ifx\temp\asisword | |
951 \else | |
952 \ifx\temp\noneword | |
953 \defaultparindent = 0pt | |
954 \else | |
955 \defaultparindent = #1em | |
956 \fi | |
957 \fi | |
958 \parindent = \defaultparindent | |
959 } | |
960 | |
961 % @exampleindent NCHARS | |
962 % We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent. | |
963 % It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but | |
964 % I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent. | |
965 \parseargdef\exampleindent{% | |
966 \def\temp{#1}% | |
967 \ifx\temp\asisword | |
968 \else | |
969 \ifx\temp\noneword | |
970 \lispnarrowing = 0pt | |
971 \else | |
972 \lispnarrowing = #1em | |
973 \fi | |
974 \fi | |
975 } | |
976 | |
977 % @firstparagraphindent WORD | |
978 % If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph | |
979 % after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such | |
980 % paragraphs. | |
981 % | |
982 % The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling | |
983 % \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do. | |
984 % We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD. | |
985 % By default, we suppress indentation. | |
986 % | |
987 \def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent} | |
988 \def\insertword{insert} | |
989 % | |
990 \parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{% | |
991 \def\temp{#1}% | |
992 \ifx\temp\noneword | |
993 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent | |
994 \else\ifx\temp\insertword | |
995 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax | |
996 \else | |
997 \errhelp = \EMsimple | |
998 \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}% | |
999 \fi\fi | |
1000 } | |
1001 | |
1002 % Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to | |
1003 % \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty. | |
1004 % | |
1005 % We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next | |
1006 % paragraph. | |
1007 % | |
1008 \gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{% | |
1009 \gdef\indent{% | |
1010 \restorefirstparagraphindent | |
1011 \indent | |
1012 }% | |
1013 \gdef\noindent{% | |
1014 \restorefirstparagraphindent | |
1015 \noindent | |
1016 }% | |
1017 \global\everypar = {% | |
1018 \kern -\parindent | |
1019 \restorefirstparagraphindent | |
1020 }% | |
1021 } | |
1022 | |
1023 \gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{% | |
1024 \global \let \indent = \ptexindent | |
1025 \global \let \noindent = \ptexnoindent | |
1026 \global \everypar = {}% | |
1027 } | |
1028 | |
1029 | |
1030 % @refill is a no-op. | |
1031 \let\refill=\relax | |
1032 | |
1033 % If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to | |
1034 % be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs. | |
1035 % This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename). | |
1036 % | |
1037 \newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files. | |
1038 \let\novalidate = \linksfalse | |
1039 | |
1040 % @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file. | |
1041 % So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input. | |
1042 % This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo. | |
1043 \def\setfilename{% | |
1044 \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'. | |
1045 \iflinks | |
1046 \tryauxfile | |
1047 % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit. | |
1048 \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux | |
1049 \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case. | |
1050 \openindices | |
1051 \let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds. | |
1052 % | |
1053 % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it. | |
1054 % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc. | |
1055 \openin 1 texinfo.cnf | |
1056 \ifeof 1 \else \input texinfo.cnf \fi | |
1057 \closein 1 | |
1058 % | |
1059 \comment % Ignore the actual filename. | |
1060 } | |
1061 | |
1062 % Called from \setfilename. | |
1063 % | |
1064 \def\openindices{% | |
1065 \newindex{cp}% | |
1066 \newcodeindex{fn}% | |
1067 \newcodeindex{vr}% | |
1068 \newcodeindex{tp}% | |
1069 \newcodeindex{ky}% | |
1070 \newcodeindex{pg}% | |
1071 } | |
1072 | |
1073 % @bye. | |
1074 \outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend} | |
1075 | |
1076 | |
1077 \message{pdf,} | |
1078 % adobe `portable' document format | |
1079 \newcount\tempnum | |
1080 \newcount\lnkcount | |
1081 \newtoks\filename | |
1082 \newcount\filenamelength | |
1083 \newcount\pgn | |
1084 \newtoks\toksA | |
1085 \newtoks\toksB | |
1086 \newtoks\toksC | |
1087 \newtoks\toksD | |
1088 \newbox\boxA | |
1089 \newcount\countA | |
1090 \newif\ifpdf | |
1091 \newif\ifpdfmakepagedest | |
1092 | |
1093 % when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1 | |
1094 % can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as being undefined. | |
1095 \ifx\pdfoutput\thisisundefined | |
1096 \else | |
1097 \ifx\pdfoutput\relax | |
1098 \else | |
1099 \ifcase\pdfoutput | |
1100 \else | |
1101 \pdftrue | |
1102 \fi | |
1103 \fi | |
1104 \fi | |
1105 | |
1106 % PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets, | |
1107 % for display in the outlines, and in other places. Thus, we have to | |
1108 % double any backslashes. Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be | |
1109 % interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e. Not good. | |
1110 % | |
1111 % See http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html and | |
1112 % related messages. The final outcome is that it is up to the TeX user | |
1113 % to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so | |
1114 % that's what we do. pdftex 1.30.0 (ca.2005) introduced a primitive to | |
1115 % do this reliably, so we use it. | |
1116 | |
1117 % #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements, | |
1118 % which we \xdef. | |
1119 \def\txiescapepdf#1{% | |
1120 \ifx\pdfescapestring\relax | |
1121 % No primitive available; should we give a warning or log? | |
1122 % Many times it won't matter. | |
1123 \else | |
1124 % The expandable \pdfescapestring primitive escapes parentheses, | |
1125 % backslashes, and other special chars. | |
1126 \xdef#1{\pdfescapestring{#1}}% | |
1127 \fi | |
1128 } | |
1129 | |
1130 \newhelp\nopdfimagehelp{Texinfo supports .png, .jpg, .jpeg, and .pdf images | |
1131 with PDF output, and none of those formats could be found. (.eps cannot | |
1132 be supported due to the design of the PDF format; use regular TeX (DVI | |
1133 output) for that.)} | |
1134 | |
1135 \ifpdf | |
1136 % | |
1137 % Color manipulation macros based on pdfcolor.tex, | |
1138 % except using rgb instead of cmyk; the latter is said to render as a | |
1139 % very dark gray on-screen and a very dark halftone in print, instead | |
1140 % of actual black. | |
1141 \def\rgbDarkRed{0.50 0.09 0.12} | |
1142 \def\rgbBlack{0 0 0} | |
1143 % | |
1144 % k sets the color for filling (usual text, etc.); | |
1145 % K sets the color for stroking (thin rules, e.g., normal _'s). | |
1146 \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\pdfliteral{#1 rg #1 RG}} | |
1147 % | |
1148 % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly, | |
1149 % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore. | |
1150 \def\setcolor#1{% | |
1151 \xdef\lastcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}% | |
1152 \domark | |
1153 \pdfsetcolor{#1}% | |
1154 } | |
1155 % | |
1156 \def\maincolor{\rgbBlack} | |
1157 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor} | |
1158 \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor} | |
1159 \def\lastcolordefs{} | |
1160 % | |
1161 \def\makefootline{% | |
1162 \baselineskip24pt | |
1163 \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}% | |
1164 } | |
1165 % | |
1166 \def\makeheadline{% | |
1167 \vbox to 0pt{% | |
1168 \vskip-22.5pt | |
1169 \line{% | |
1170 \vbox to8.5pt{}% | |
1171 % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks. | |
1172 \getcolormarks | |
1173 % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color. | |
1174 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}% | |
1175 }% | |
1176 \vss | |
1177 }% | |
1178 \nointerlineskip | |
1179 } | |
1180 % | |
1181 % | |
1182 \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines} | |
1183 % | |
1184 % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto). | |
1185 \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{% | |
1186 \def\pdfimagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% | |
1187 \def\pdfimageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}% | |
1188 % | |
1189 % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .pdf, .png, .jpg (among | |
1190 % others). Let's try in that order, PDF first since if | |
1191 % someone has a scalable image, presumably better to use that than a | |
1192 % bitmap. | |
1193 \let\pdfimgext=\empty | |
1194 \begingroup | |
1195 \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1 | |
1196 \openin 1 #1.PDF \ifeof 1 | |
1197 \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1 | |
1198 \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1 | |
1199 \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1 | |
1200 \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1 | |
1201 \errhelp = \nopdfimagehelp | |
1202 \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for pdf}% | |
1203 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG}% | |
1204 \fi | |
1205 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg}% | |
1206 \fi | |
1207 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg}% | |
1208 \fi | |
1209 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png}% | |
1210 \fi | |
1211 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{PDF}% | |
1212 \fi | |
1213 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf}% | |
1214 \fi | |
1215 \closein 1 | |
1216 \endgroup | |
1217 % | |
1218 % without \immediate, ancient pdftex seg faults when the same image is | |
1219 % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.) | |
1220 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 | |
1221 \immediate\pdfimage | |
1222 \else | |
1223 \immediate\pdfximage | |
1224 \fi | |
1225 \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \pdfimagewidth \fi | |
1226 \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \pdfimageheight \fi | |
1227 \ifnum\pdftexversion<13 | |
1228 #1.\pdfimgext | |
1229 \else | |
1230 {#1.\pdfimgext}% | |
1231 \fi | |
1232 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else | |
1233 \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage | |
1234 \fi} | |
1235 % | |
1236 \def\pdfmkdest#1{{% | |
1237 % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters | |
1238 % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title. | |
1239 \indexnofonts | |
1240 \turnoffactive | |
1241 \makevalueexpandable | |
1242 \def\pdfdestname{#1}% | |
1243 \txiescapepdf\pdfdestname | |
1244 \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}% | |
1245 }} | |
1246 % | |
1247 % used to mark target names; must be expandable. | |
1248 \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1} | |
1249 % | |
1250 % by default, use a color that is dark enough to print on paper as | |
1251 % nearly black, but still distinguishable for online viewing. | |
1252 \def\urlcolor{\rgbDarkRed} | |
1253 \def\linkcolor{\rgbDarkRed} | |
1254 \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink} | |
1255 % | |
1256 % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines | |
1257 % come from Petr Olsak | |
1258 \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0% | |
1259 \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi} | |
1260 \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax | |
1261 \advance\tempnum by 1 | |
1262 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}} | |
1263 % | |
1264 % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the | |
1265 % outline by the pdf viewer. #2 is the pdf expression for the number | |
1266 % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node text, | |
1267 % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node. | |
1268 % #4 is the page number | |
1269 % | |
1270 \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{% | |
1271 % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the | |
1272 % page number. We could generate a destination for the section | |
1273 % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't | |
1274 % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured. | |
1275 \edef\pdfoutlinedest{#3}% | |
1276 \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty | |
1277 \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}% | |
1278 \else | |
1279 \txiescapepdf\pdfoutlinedest | |
1280 \fi | |
1281 % | |
1282 % Also escape PDF chars in the display string. | |
1283 \edef\pdfoutlinetext{#1}% | |
1284 \txiescapepdf\pdfoutlinetext | |
1285 % | |
1286 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}% | |
1287 } | |
1288 % | |
1289 \def\pdfmakeoutlines{% | |
1290 \begingroup | |
1291 % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline. | |
1292 \def\partentry##1##2##3##4{}% ignore parts in the outlines | |
1293 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{% | |
1294 \def\thischapnum{##2}% | |
1295 \def\thissecnum{0}% | |
1296 \def\thissubsecnum{0}% | |
1297 }% | |
1298 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{% | |
1299 \advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}% | |
1300 \def\thissecnum{##2}% | |
1301 \def\thissubsecnum{0}% | |
1302 }% | |
1303 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% | |
1304 \advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}% | |
1305 \def\thissubsecnum{##2}% | |
1306 }% | |
1307 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% | |
1308 \advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}% | |
1309 }% | |
1310 \def\thischapnum{0}% | |
1311 \def\thissecnum{0}% | |
1312 \def\thissubsecnum{0}% | |
1313 % | |
1314 % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et | |
1315 % al. a second time, below. | |
1316 \def\appentry{\numchapentry}% | |
1317 \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}% | |
1318 \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}% | |
1319 \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}% | |
1320 \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}% | |
1321 \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}% | |
1322 \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}% | |
1323 \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}% | |
1324 \readdatafile{toc}% | |
1325 % | |
1326 % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines. | |
1327 % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of | |
1328 % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above. | |
1329 % | |
1330 % We use the node names as the destinations. | |
1331 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{% | |
1332 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}% | |
1333 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{% | |
1334 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}% | |
1335 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% | |
1336 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}% | |
1337 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero | |
1338 \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}% | |
1339 % | |
1340 % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of | |
1341 % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters, | |
1342 % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from | |
1343 % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from | |
1344 % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100. | |
1345 % | |
1346 % TODO this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to | |
1347 % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Too | |
1348 % much work for too little return. Just use the ASCII equivalents | |
1349 % we use for the index sort strings. | |
1350 % | |
1351 \indexnofonts | |
1352 \setupdatafile | |
1353 % We can have normal brace characters in the PDF outlines, unlike | |
1354 % Texinfo index files. So set that up. | |
1355 \def\{{\lbracecharliteral}% | |
1356 \def\}{\rbracecharliteral}% | |
1357 \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash | |
1358 \input \tocreadfilename | |
1359 \endgroup | |
1360 } | |
1361 {\catcode`[=1 \catcode`]=2 | |
1362 \catcode`{=\other \catcode`}=\other | |
1363 \gdef\lbracecharliteral[{]% | |
1364 \gdef\rbracecharliteral[}]% | |
1365 ] | |
1366 % | |
1367 \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}% | |
1368 \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax | |
1369 \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces | |
1370 \ifx\p\space\else\addtokens{\filename}{\PP}% | |
1371 \advance\filenamelength by 1 | |
1372 \fi | |
1373 \fi | |
1374 \nextsp} | |
1375 \def\getfilename#1{% | |
1376 \filenamelength=0 | |
1377 % If we don't expand the argument now, \skipspaces will get | |
1378 % snagged on things like "@value{foo}". | |
1379 \edef\temp{#1}% | |
1380 \expandafter\skipspaces\temp|\relax | |
1381 } | |
1382 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 | |
1383 \let \startlink \pdfannotlink | |
1384 \else | |
1385 \let \startlink \pdfstartlink | |
1386 \fi | |
1387 % make a live url in pdf output. | |
1388 \def\pdfurl#1{% | |
1389 \begingroup | |
1390 % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not | |
1391 % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context | |
1392 % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one | |
1393 % people have actually reported a problem with. | |
1394 % | |
1395 \normalturnoffactive | |
1396 \def\@{@}% | |
1397 \let\/=\empty | |
1398 \makevalueexpandable | |
1399 % do we want to go so far as to use \indexnofonts instead of just | |
1400 % special-casing \var here? | |
1401 \def\var##1{##1}% | |
1402 % | |
1403 \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}% | |
1404 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% | |
1405 user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}% | |
1406 \endgroup} | |
1407 \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}} | |
1408 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks} | |
1409 \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks} | |
1410 \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}} | |
1411 \def\maketoks{% | |
1412 \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax | |
1413 \ifx\first0\adn0 | |
1414 \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3 | |
1415 \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6 | |
1416 \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9 | |
1417 \else | |
1418 \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi | |
1419 \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else | |
1420 \let\next=\maketoks | |
1421 \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD} | |
1422 \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi | |
1423 \fi | |
1424 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi | |
1425 \next} | |
1426 \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}% | |
1427 {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0} | |
1428 \def\pdflink#1{% | |
1429 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}} | |
1430 \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink} | |
1431 \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st} | |
1432 \else | |
1433 % non-pdf mode | |
1434 \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble | |
1435 \let\pdfurl = \gobble | |
1436 \let\endlink = \relax | |
1437 \let\setcolor = \gobble | |
1438 \let\pdfsetcolor = \gobble | |
1439 \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax | |
1440 \fi % \ifx\pdfoutput | |
1441 | |
1442 | |
1443 \message{fonts,} | |
1444 | |
1445 % Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle. | |
1446 % For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in | |
1447 % italics, not bold italics. | |
1448 % | |
1449 \def\setfontstyle#1{% | |
1450 \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd. | |
1451 \csname ten#1\endcsname % change the current font | |
1452 } | |
1453 | |
1454 % Select #1 fonts with the current style. | |
1455 % | |
1456 \def\selectfonts#1{\csname #1fonts\endcsname \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname} | |
1457 | |
1458 \def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}} | |
1459 \def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}} | |
1460 \def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}} | |
1461 \def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf} | |
1462 \def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}} | |
1463 | |
1464 % Unfortunately, we have to override this for titles and the like, since | |
1465 % in those cases "rm" is bold. Sigh. | |
1466 \def\rmisbold{\rm\def\curfontstyle{bf}} | |
1467 | |
1468 % Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not. | |
1469 % So we set up a \sf. | |
1470 \newfam\sffam | |
1471 \def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}} | |
1472 \let\li = \sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf. | |
1473 | |
1474 % We don't need math for this font style. | |
1475 \def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}} | |
1476 | |
1477 | |
1478 % Default leading. | |
1479 \newdimen\textleading \textleading = 13.2pt | |
1480 | |
1481 % Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size | |
1482 % correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers | |
1483 % used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined. | |
1484 % | |
1485 \def\lineskipfactor{.08333} | |
1486 \def\strutheightpercent{.70833} | |
1487 \def\strutdepthpercent {.29167} | |
1488 % | |
1489 % can get a sort of poor man's double spacing by redefining this. | |
1490 \def\baselinefactor{1} | |
1491 % | |
1492 \def\setleading#1{% | |
1493 \dimen0 = #1\relax | |
1494 \normalbaselineskip = \baselinefactor\dimen0 | |
1495 \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip | |
1496 \normalbaselines | |
1497 \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{% | |
1498 \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip | |
1499 depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip | |
1500 }% | |
1501 } | |
1502 | |
1503 % PDF CMaps. See also LaTeX's t1.cmap. | |
1504 % | |
1505 % do nothing with this by default. | |
1506 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1\endcsname\gobble | |
1507 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname\gobble | |
1508 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname\gobble | |
1509 | |
1510 % if we are producing pdf, and we have \pdffontattr, then define cmaps. | |
1511 % (\pdffontattr was introduced many years ago, but people still run | |
1512 % older pdftex's; it's easy to conditionalize, so we do.) | |
1513 \ifpdf \ifx\pdffontattr\thisisundefined \else | |
1514 \begingroup | |
1515 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char. | |
1516 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap | |
1517 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit) | |
1518 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit) | |
1519 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1-0) | |
1520 %%Title: (TeX-OT1-0 TeX OT1 0) | |
1521 %%Version: 1.000 | |
1522 %%EndComments | |
1523 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin | |
1524 12 dict begin | |
1525 begincmap | |
1526 /CIDSystemInfo | |
1527 << /Registry (TeX) | |
1528 /Ordering (OT1) | |
1529 /Supplement 0 | |
1530 >> def | |
1531 /CMapName /TeX-OT1-0 def | |
1532 /CMapType 2 def | |
1533 1 begincodespacerange | |
1534 <00> <7F> | |
1535 endcodespacerange | |
1536 8 beginbfrange | |
1537 <00> <01> <0393> | |
1538 <09> <0A> <03A8> | |
1539 <23> <26> <0023> | |
1540 <28> <3B> <0028> | |
1541 <3F> <5B> <003F> | |
1542 <5D> <5E> <005D> | |
1543 <61> <7A> <0061> | |
1544 <7B> <7C> <2013> | |
1545 endbfrange | |
1546 40 beginbfchar | |
1547 <02> <0398> | |
1548 <03> <039B> | |
1549 <04> <039E> | |
1550 <05> <03A0> | |
1551 <06> <03A3> | |
1552 <07> <03D2> | |
1553 <08> <03A6> | |
1554 <0B> <00660066> | |
1555 <0C> <00660069> | |
1556 <0D> <0066006C> | |
1557 <0E> <006600660069> | |
1558 <0F> <00660066006C> | |
1559 <10> <0131> | |
1560 <11> <0237> | |
1561 <12> <0060> | |
1562 <13> <00B4> | |
1563 <14> <02C7> | |
1564 <15> <02D8> | |
1565 <16> <00AF> | |
1566 <17> <02DA> | |
1567 <18> <00B8> | |
1568 <19> <00DF> | |
1569 <1A> <00E6> | |
1570 <1B> <0153> | |
1571 <1C> <00F8> | |
1572 <1D> <00C6> | |
1573 <1E> <0152> | |
1574 <1F> <00D8> | |
1575 <21> <0021> | |
1576 <22> <201D> | |
1577 <27> <2019> | |
1578 <3C> <00A1> | |
1579 <3D> <003D> | |
1580 <3E> <00BF> | |
1581 <5C> <201C> | |
1582 <5F> <02D9> | |
1583 <60> <2018> | |
1584 <7D> <02DD> | |
1585 <7E> <007E> | |
1586 <7F> <00A8> | |
1587 endbfchar | |
1588 endcmap | |
1589 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop | |
1590 end | |
1591 end | |
1592 %%EndResource | |
1593 %%EOF | |
1594 }\endgroup | |
1595 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1\endcsname#1{% | |
1596 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}% | |
1597 }% | |
1598 % | |
1599 % \cmapOT1IT | |
1600 \begingroup | |
1601 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char. | |
1602 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap | |
1603 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit) | |
1604 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit) | |
1605 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1IT-0) | |
1606 %%Title: (TeX-OT1IT-0 TeX OT1IT 0) | |
1607 %%Version: 1.000 | |
1608 %%EndComments | |
1609 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin | |
1610 12 dict begin | |
1611 begincmap | |
1612 /CIDSystemInfo | |
1613 << /Registry (TeX) | |
1614 /Ordering (OT1IT) | |
1615 /Supplement 0 | |
1616 >> def | |
1617 /CMapName /TeX-OT1IT-0 def | |
1618 /CMapType 2 def | |
1619 1 begincodespacerange | |
1620 <00> <7F> | |
1621 endcodespacerange | |
1622 8 beginbfrange | |
1623 <00> <01> <0393> | |
1624 <09> <0A> <03A8> | |
1625 <25> <26> <0025> | |
1626 <28> <3B> <0028> | |
1627 <3F> <5B> <003F> | |
1628 <5D> <5E> <005D> | |
1629 <61> <7A> <0061> | |
1630 <7B> <7C> <2013> | |
1631 endbfrange | |
1632 42 beginbfchar | |
1633 <02> <0398> | |
1634 <03> <039B> | |
1635 <04> <039E> | |
1636 <05> <03A0> | |
1637 <06> <03A3> | |
1638 <07> <03D2> | |
1639 <08> <03A6> | |
1640 <0B> <00660066> | |
1641 <0C> <00660069> | |
1642 <0D> <0066006C> | |
1643 <0E> <006600660069> | |
1644 <0F> <00660066006C> | |
1645 <10> <0131> | |
1646 <11> <0237> | |
1647 <12> <0060> | |
1648 <13> <00B4> | |
1649 <14> <02C7> | |
1650 <15> <02D8> | |
1651 <16> <00AF> | |
1652 <17> <02DA> | |
1653 <18> <00B8> | |
1654 <19> <00DF> | |
1655 <1A> <00E6> | |
1656 <1B> <0153> | |
1657 <1C> <00F8> | |
1658 <1D> <00C6> | |
1659 <1E> <0152> | |
1660 <1F> <00D8> | |
1661 <21> <0021> | |
1662 <22> <201D> | |
1663 <23> <0023> | |
1664 <24> <00A3> | |
1665 <27> <2019> | |
1666 <3C> <00A1> | |
1667 <3D> <003D> | |
1668 <3E> <00BF> | |
1669 <5C> <201C> | |
1670 <5F> <02D9> | |
1671 <60> <2018> | |
1672 <7D> <02DD> | |
1673 <7E> <007E> | |
1674 <7F> <00A8> | |
1675 endbfchar | |
1676 endcmap | |
1677 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop | |
1678 end | |
1679 end | |
1680 %%EndResource | |
1681 %%EOF | |
1682 }\endgroup | |
1683 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname#1{% | |
1684 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}% | |
1685 }% | |
1686 % | |
1687 % \cmapOT1TT | |
1688 \begingroup | |
1689 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char. | |
1690 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap | |
1691 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit) | |
1692 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit) | |
1693 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1TT-0) | |
1694 %%Title: (TeX-OT1TT-0 TeX OT1TT 0) | |
1695 %%Version: 1.000 | |
1696 %%EndComments | |
1697 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin | |
1698 12 dict begin | |
1699 begincmap | |
1700 /CIDSystemInfo | |
1701 << /Registry (TeX) | |
1702 /Ordering (OT1TT) | |
1703 /Supplement 0 | |
1704 >> def | |
1705 /CMapName /TeX-OT1TT-0 def | |
1706 /CMapType 2 def | |
1707 1 begincodespacerange | |
1708 <00> <7F> | |
1709 endcodespacerange | |
1710 5 beginbfrange | |
1711 <00> <01> <0393> | |
1712 <09> <0A> <03A8> | |
1713 <21> <26> <0021> | |
1714 <28> <5F> <0028> | |
1715 <61> <7E> <0061> | |
1716 endbfrange | |
1717 32 beginbfchar | |
1718 <02> <0398> | |
1719 <03> <039B> | |
1720 <04> <039E> | |
1721 <05> <03A0> | |
1722 <06> <03A3> | |
1723 <07> <03D2> | |
1724 <08> <03A6> | |
1725 <0B> <2191> | |
1726 <0C> <2193> | |
1727 <0D> <0027> | |
1728 <0E> <00A1> | |
1729 <0F> <00BF> | |
1730 <10> <0131> | |
1731 <11> <0237> | |
1732 <12> <0060> | |
1733 <13> <00B4> | |
1734 <14> <02C7> | |
1735 <15> <02D8> | |
1736 <16> <00AF> | |
1737 <17> <02DA> | |
1738 <18> <00B8> | |
1739 <19> <00DF> | |
1740 <1A> <00E6> | |
1741 <1B> <0153> | |
1742 <1C> <00F8> | |
1743 <1D> <00C6> | |
1744 <1E> <0152> | |
1745 <1F> <00D8> | |
1746 <20> <2423> | |
1747 <27> <2019> | |
1748 <60> <2018> | |
1749 <7F> <00A8> | |
1750 endbfchar | |
1751 endcmap | |
1752 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop | |
1753 end | |
1754 end | |
1755 %%EndResource | |
1756 %%EOF | |
1757 }\endgroup | |
1758 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname#1{% | |
1759 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}% | |
1760 }% | |
1761 \fi\fi | |
1762 | |
1763 | |
1764 % Set the font macro #1 to the font named #2, adding on the | |
1765 % specified font prefix (normally `cm'). | |
1766 % #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor, #5 is the CMap | |
1767 % encoding (currently only OT1, OT1IT and OT1TT are allowed, pass | |
1768 % empty to omit). | |
1769 \def\setfont#1#2#3#4#5{% | |
1770 \font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4 | |
1771 \csname cmap#5\endcsname#1% | |
1772 } | |
1773 % This is what gets called when #5 of \setfont is empty. | |
1774 \let\cmap\gobble | |
1775 % emacs-page end of cmaps | |
1776 | |
1777 % Use cm as the default font prefix. | |
1778 % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix | |
1779 % before you read in texinfo.tex. | |
1780 \ifx\fontprefix\thisisundefined | |
1781 \def\fontprefix{cm} | |
1782 \fi | |
1783 % Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM. | |
1784 \def\rmshape{r} | |
1785 \def\rmbshape{bx} %where the normal face is bold | |
1786 \def\bfshape{b} | |
1787 \def\bxshape{bx} | |
1788 \def\ttshape{tt} | |
1789 \def\ttbshape{tt} | |
1790 \def\ttslshape{sltt} | |
1791 \def\itshape{ti} | |
1792 \def\itbshape{bxti} | |
1793 \def\slshape{sl} | |
1794 \def\slbshape{bxsl} | |
1795 \def\sfshape{ss} | |
1796 \def\sfbshape{ss} | |
1797 \def\scshape{csc} | |
1798 \def\scbshape{csc} | |
1799 | |
1800 % Definitions for a main text size of 11pt. This is the default in | |
1801 % Texinfo. | |
1802 % | |
1803 \def\definetextfontsizexi{% | |
1804 % Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1). | |
1805 \def\textnominalsize{11pt} | |
1806 \edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf} | |
1807 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} | |
1808 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT} | |
1809 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} | |
1810 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT} | |
1811 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} | |
1812 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} | |
1813 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} | |
1814 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT} | |
1815 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep | |
1816 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep | |
1817 \def\textecsize{1095} | |
1818 | |
1819 % A few fonts for @defun names and args. | |
1820 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} | |
1821 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT} | |
1822 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT} | |
1823 \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf} | |
1824 | |
1825 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt). | |
1826 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt} | |
1827 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1} | |
1828 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT} | |
1829 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1} | |
1830 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT} | |
1831 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1} | |
1832 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1} | |
1833 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1} | |
1834 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT} | |
1835 \font\smalli=cmmi9 | |
1836 \font\smallsy=cmsy9 | |
1837 \def\smallecsize{0900} | |
1838 | |
1839 % Fonts for small examples (8pt). | |
1840 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt} | |
1841 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1} | |
1842 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT} | |
1843 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1} | |
1844 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT} | |
1845 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1} | |
1846 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1} | |
1847 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1} | |
1848 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT} | |
1849 \font\smalleri=cmmi8 | |
1850 \font\smallersy=cmsy8 | |
1851 \def\smallerecsize{0800} | |
1852 | |
1853 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt): | |
1854 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt} | |
1855 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1} | |
1856 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT} | |
1857 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1} | |
1858 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT} | |
1859 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT} | |
1860 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1} | |
1861 \let\titlebf=\titlerm | |
1862 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1} | |
1863 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3 | |
1864 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4 | |
1865 \def\titleecsize{2074} | |
1866 | |
1867 % Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt). | |
1868 \def\chapnominalsize{17pt} | |
1869 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1} | |
1870 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1IT} | |
1871 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1} | |
1872 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1TT} | |
1873 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1TT} | |
1874 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}{OT1} | |
1875 \let\chapbf=\chaprm | |
1876 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1} | |
1877 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2 | |
1878 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3 | |
1879 \def\chapecsize{1728} | |
1880 | |
1881 % Section fonts (14.4pt). | |
1882 \def\secnominalsize{14pt} | |
1883 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1} | |
1884 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT} | |
1885 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1} | |
1886 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT} | |
1887 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT} | |
1888 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1} | |
1889 \let\secbf\secrm | |
1890 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1} | |
1891 \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1 | |
1892 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2 | |
1893 \def\sececsize{1440} | |
1894 | |
1895 % Subsection fonts (13.15pt). | |
1896 \def\ssecnominalsize{13pt} | |
1897 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1} | |
1898 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}{OT1IT} | |
1899 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}{OT1} | |
1900 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT} | |
1901 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}{OT1TT} | |
1902 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1} | |
1903 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm | |
1904 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}{OT1} | |
1905 \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf | |
1906 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315 | |
1907 \def\ssececsize{1200} | |
1908 | |
1909 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt). | |
1910 \def\reducednominalsize{10pt} | |
1911 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}{OT1} | |
1912 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT} | |
1913 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}{OT1} | |
1914 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT} | |
1915 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}{OT1} | |
1916 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}{OT1} | |
1917 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}{OT1} | |
1918 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT} | |
1919 \font\reducedi=cmmi10 | |
1920 \font\reducedsy=cmsy10 | |
1921 \def\reducedecsize{1000} | |
1922 | |
1923 \textleading = 13.2pt % line spacing for 11pt CM | |
1924 \textfonts % reset the current fonts | |
1925 \rm | |
1926 } % end of 11pt text font size definitions | |
1927 | |
1928 | |
1929 % Definitions to make the main text be 10pt Computer Modern, with | |
1930 % section, chapter, etc., sizes following suit. This is for the GNU | |
1931 % Press printing of the Emacs 22 manual. Maybe other manuals in the | |
1932 % future. Used with @smallbook, which sets the leading to 12pt. | |
1933 % | |
1934 \def\definetextfontsizex{% | |
1935 % Text fonts (10pt). | |
1936 \def\textnominalsize{10pt} | |
1937 \edef\mainmagstep{1000} | |
1938 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} | |
1939 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT} | |
1940 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} | |
1941 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT} | |
1942 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} | |
1943 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} | |
1944 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} | |
1945 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT} | |
1946 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep | |
1947 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep | |
1948 \def\textecsize{1000} | |
1949 | |
1950 % A few fonts for @defun names and args. | |
1951 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1} | |
1952 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT} | |
1953 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT} | |
1954 \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf} | |
1955 | |
1956 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt). | |
1957 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt} | |
1958 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1} | |
1959 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT} | |
1960 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1} | |
1961 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT} | |
1962 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1} | |
1963 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1} | |
1964 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1} | |
1965 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT} | |
1966 \font\smalli=cmmi9 | |
1967 \font\smallsy=cmsy9 | |
1968 \def\smallecsize{0900} | |
1969 | |
1970 % Fonts for small examples (8pt). | |
1971 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt} | |
1972 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1} | |
1973 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT} | |
1974 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1} | |
1975 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT} | |
1976 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1} | |
1977 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1} | |
1978 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1} | |
1979 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT} | |
1980 \font\smalleri=cmmi8 | |
1981 \font\smallersy=cmsy8 | |
1982 \def\smallerecsize{0800} | |
1983 | |
1984 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt): | |
1985 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt} | |
1986 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1} | |
1987 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT} | |
1988 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1} | |
1989 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT} | |
1990 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT} | |
1991 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1} | |
1992 \let\titlebf=\titlerm | |
1993 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1} | |
1994 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3 | |
1995 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4 | |
1996 \def\titleecsize{2074} | |
1997 | |
1998 % Chapter fonts (14.4pt). | |
1999 \def\chapnominalsize{14pt} | |
2000 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1} | |
2001 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT} | |
2002 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1} | |
2003 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT} | |
2004 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT} | |
2005 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1} | |
2006 \let\chapbf\chaprm | |
2007 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1} | |
2008 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1 | |
2009 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2 | |
2010 \def\chapecsize{1440} | |
2011 | |
2012 % Section fonts (12pt). | |
2013 \def\secnominalsize{12pt} | |
2014 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}{OT1} | |
2015 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1IT} | |
2016 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} | |
2017 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT} | |
2018 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT} | |
2019 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}{OT1} | |
2020 \let\secbf\secrm | |
2021 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} | |
2022 \font\seci=cmmi12 | |
2023 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep1 | |
2024 \def\sececsize{1200} | |
2025 | |
2026 % Subsection fonts (10pt). | |
2027 \def\ssecnominalsize{10pt} | |
2028 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}{OT1} | |
2029 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT} | |
2030 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}{OT1} | |
2031 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT} | |
2032 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT} | |
2033 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}{OT1} | |
2034 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm | |
2035 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}{OT1} | |
2036 \font\sseci=cmmi10 | |
2037 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 | |
2038 \def\ssececsize{1000} | |
2039 | |
2040 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (9pt). | |
2041 \def\reducednominalsize{9pt} | |
2042 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1} | |
2043 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT} | |
2044 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1} | |
2045 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT} | |
2046 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1} | |
2047 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1} | |
2048 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1} | |
2049 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT} | |
2050 \font\reducedi=cmmi9 | |
2051 \font\reducedsy=cmsy9 | |
2052 \def\reducedecsize{0900} | |
2053 | |
2054 \divide\parskip by 2 % reduce space between paragraphs | |
2055 \textleading = 12pt % line spacing for 10pt CM | |
2056 \textfonts % reset the current fonts | |
2057 \rm | |
2058 } % end of 10pt text font size definitions | |
2059 | |
2060 | |
2061 % We provide the user-level command | |
2062 % @fonttextsize 10 | |
2063 % (or 11) to redefine the text font size. pt is assumed. | |
2064 % | |
2065 \def\xiword{11} | |
2066 \def\xword{10} | |
2067 \def\xwordpt{10pt} | |
2068 % | |
2069 \parseargdef\fonttextsize{% | |
2070 \def\textsizearg{#1}% | |
2071 %\wlog{doing @fonttextsize \textsizearg}% | |
2072 % | |
2073 % Set \globaldefs so that documents can use this inside @tex, since | |
2074 % makeinfo 4.8 does not support it, but we need it nonetheless. | |
2075 % | |
2076 \begingroup \globaldefs=1 | |
2077 \ifx\textsizearg\xword \definetextfontsizex | |
2078 \else \ifx\textsizearg\xiword \definetextfontsizexi | |
2079 \else | |
2080 \errhelp=\EMsimple | |
2081 \errmessage{@fonttextsize only supports `10' or `11', not `\textsizearg'} | |
2082 \fi\fi | |
2083 \endgroup | |
2084 } | |
2085 | |
2086 | |
2087 % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters, | |
2088 % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. Since | |
2089 % texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts except | |
2090 % in the main text, we don't bother to reset \scriptfont and | |
2091 % \scriptscriptfont (which would also require loading a lot more fonts). | |
2092 % | |
2093 \def\resetmathfonts{% | |
2094 \textfont0=\tenrm \textfont1=\teni \textfont2=\tensy | |
2095 \textfont\itfam=\tenit \textfont\slfam=\tensl \textfont\bffam=\tenbf | |
2096 \textfont\ttfam=\tentt \textfont\sffam=\tensf | |
2097 } | |
2098 | |
2099 % The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead | |
2100 % of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs to also set the | |
2101 % current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm) commands hardwire | |
2102 % \tenSTYLE to set the current font. | |
2103 % | |
2104 % Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower) | |
2105 % and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used in | |
2106 % the LaTeX logo and acronyms. | |
2107 % | |
2108 % This all needs generalizing, badly. | |
2109 % | |
2110 \def\textfonts{% | |
2111 \let\tenrm=\textrm \let\tenit=\textit \let\tensl=\textsl | |
2112 \let\tenbf=\textbf \let\tentt=\texttt \let\smallcaps=\textsc | |
2113 \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy | |
2114 \let\tenttsl=\textttsl | |
2115 \def\curfontsize{text}% | |
2116 \def\lsize{reduced}\def\lllsize{smaller}% | |
2117 \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}} | |
2118 \def\titlefonts{% | |
2119 \let\tenrm=\titlerm \let\tenit=\titleit \let\tensl=\titlesl | |
2120 \let\tenbf=\titlebf \let\tentt=\titlett \let\smallcaps=\titlesc | |
2121 \let\tensf=\titlesf \let\teni=\titlei \let\tensy=\titlesy | |
2122 \let\tenttsl=\titlettsl | |
2123 \def\curfontsize{title}% | |
2124 \def\lsize{chap}\def\lllsize{subsec}% | |
2125 \resetmathfonts \setleading{27pt}} | |
2126 \def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rmisbold #1}} | |
2127 \def\chapfonts{% | |
2128 \let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl | |
2129 \let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc | |
2130 \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy | |
2131 \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl | |
2132 \def\curfontsize{chap}% | |
2133 \def\lsize{sec}\def\lllsize{text}% | |
2134 \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt}} | |
2135 \def\secfonts{% | |
2136 \let\tenrm=\secrm \let\tenit=\secit \let\tensl=\secsl | |
2137 \let\tenbf=\secbf \let\tentt=\sectt \let\smallcaps=\secsc | |
2138 \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy | |
2139 \let\tenttsl=\secttsl | |
2140 \def\curfontsize{sec}% | |
2141 \def\lsize{subsec}\def\lllsize{reduced}% | |
2142 \resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt}} | |
2143 \def\subsecfonts{% | |
2144 \let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl | |
2145 \let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc | |
2146 \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy | |
2147 \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl | |
2148 \def\curfontsize{ssec}% | |
2149 \def\lsize{text}\def\lllsize{small}% | |
2150 \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt}} | |
2151 \let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts | |
2152 \def\reducedfonts{% | |
2153 \let\tenrm=\reducedrm \let\tenit=\reducedit \let\tensl=\reducedsl | |
2154 \let\tenbf=\reducedbf \let\tentt=\reducedtt \let\reducedcaps=\reducedsc | |
2155 \let\tensf=\reducedsf \let\teni=\reducedi \let\tensy=\reducedsy | |
2156 \let\tenttsl=\reducedttsl | |
2157 \def\curfontsize{reduced}% | |
2158 \def\lsize{small}\def\lllsize{smaller}% | |
2159 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}} | |
2160 \def\smallfonts{% | |
2161 \let\tenrm=\smallrm \let\tenit=\smallit \let\tensl=\smallsl | |
2162 \let\tenbf=\smallbf \let\tentt=\smalltt \let\smallcaps=\smallsc | |
2163 \let\tensf=\smallsf \let\teni=\smalli \let\tensy=\smallsy | |
2164 \let\tenttsl=\smallttsl | |
2165 \def\curfontsize{small}% | |
2166 \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}% | |
2167 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}} | |
2168 \def\smallerfonts{% | |
2169 \let\tenrm=\smallerrm \let\tenit=\smallerit \let\tensl=\smallersl | |
2170 \let\tenbf=\smallerbf \let\tentt=\smallertt \let\smallcaps=\smallersc | |
2171 \let\tensf=\smallersf \let\teni=\smalleri \let\tensy=\smallersy | |
2172 \let\tenttsl=\smallerttsl | |
2173 \def\curfontsize{smaller}% | |
2174 \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}% | |
2175 \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt}} | |
2176 | |
2177 % Fonts for short table of contents. | |
2178 \setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}{OT1} | |
2179 \setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} % no cmb12 | |
2180 \setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}{OT1} | |
2181 \setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT} | |
2182 | |
2183 % Define these just so they can be easily changed for other fonts. | |
2184 \def\angleleft{$\langle$} | |
2185 \def\angleright{$\rangle$} | |
2186 | |
2187 % Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments. | |
2188 \let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts | |
2189 | |
2190 % About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample | |
2191 % can fit this many characters: | |
2192 % 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69 | |
2193 % If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters: | |
2194 % 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77 | |
2195 % For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth | |
2196 % the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt. | |
2197 % | |
2198 % By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt): | |
2199 % 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58 | |
2200 % --karl, 24jan03. | |
2201 | |
2202 % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes. | |
2203 % | |
2204 \definetextfontsizexi | |
2205 | |
2206 | |
2207 \message{markup,} | |
2208 | |
2209 % Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the | |
2210 % Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and | |
2211 % shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have | |
2212 % this property, we can check that font parameter. | |
2213 % | |
2214 \def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt } | |
2215 | |
2216 % Markup style infrastructure. \defmarkupstylesetup\INITMACRO will | |
2217 % define and register \INITMACRO to be called on markup style changes. | |
2218 % \INITMACRO can check \currentmarkupstyle for the innermost | |
2219 % style and the set of \ifmarkupSTYLE switches for all styles | |
2220 % currently in effect. | |
2221 \newif\ifmarkupvar | |
2222 \newif\ifmarkupsamp | |
2223 \newif\ifmarkupkey | |
2224 %\newif\ifmarkupfile % @file == @samp. | |
2225 %\newif\ifmarkupoption % @option == @samp. | |
2226 \newif\ifmarkupcode | |
2227 \newif\ifmarkupkbd | |
2228 %\newif\ifmarkupenv % @env == @code. | |
2229 %\newif\ifmarkupcommand % @command == @code. | |
2230 \newif\ifmarkuptex % @tex (and part of @math, for now). | |
2231 \newif\ifmarkupexample | |
2232 \newif\ifmarkupverb | |
2233 \newif\ifmarkupverbatim | |
2234 | |
2235 \let\currentmarkupstyle\empty | |
2236 | |
2237 \def\setupmarkupstyle#1{% | |
2238 \csname markup#1true\endcsname | |
2239 \def\currentmarkupstyle{#1}% | |
2240 \markupstylesetup | |
2241 } | |
2242 | |
2243 \let\markupstylesetup\empty | |
2244 | |
2245 \def\defmarkupstylesetup#1{% | |
2246 \expandafter\def\expandafter\markupstylesetup | |
2247 \expandafter{\markupstylesetup #1}% | |
2248 \def#1% | |
2249 } | |
2250 | |
2251 % Markup style setup for left and right quotes. | |
2252 \defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuplq{% | |
2253 \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp | |
2254 \csname markupsetuplq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname | |
2255 \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuplqdefault \else \temp \fi | |
2256 } | |
2257 | |
2258 \defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuprq{% | |
2259 \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp | |
2260 \csname markupsetuprq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname | |
2261 \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuprqdefault \else \temp \fi | |
2262 } | |
2263 | |
2264 { | |
2265 \catcode`\'=\active | |
2266 \catcode`\`=\active | |
2267 | |
2268 \gdef\markupsetuplqdefault{\let`\lq} | |
2269 \gdef\markupsetuprqdefault{\let'\rq} | |
2270 | |
2271 \gdef\markupsetcodequoteleft{\let`\codequoteleft} | |
2272 \gdef\markupsetcodequoteright{\let'\codequoteright} | |
2273 | |
2274 \gdef\markupsetnoligaturesquoteleft{\let`\noligaturesquoteleft} | |
2275 } | |
2276 | |
2277 \let\markupsetuplqcode \markupsetcodequoteleft | |
2278 \let\markupsetuprqcode \markupsetcodequoteright | |
2279 % | |
2280 \let\markupsetuplqexample \markupsetcodequoteleft | |
2281 \let\markupsetuprqexample \markupsetcodequoteright | |
2282 % | |
2283 \let\markupsetuplqsamp \markupsetcodequoteleft | |
2284 \let\markupsetuprqsamp \markupsetcodequoteright | |
2285 % | |
2286 \let\markupsetuplqverb \markupsetcodequoteleft | |
2287 \let\markupsetuprqverb \markupsetcodequoteright | |
2288 % | |
2289 \let\markupsetuplqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteleft | |
2290 \let\markupsetuprqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteright | |
2291 | |
2292 \let\markupsetuplqkbd \markupsetnoligaturesquoteleft | |
2293 | |
2294 % Allow an option to not use regular directed right quote/apostrophe | |
2295 % (char 0x27), but instead the undirected quote from cmtt (char 0x0d). | |
2296 % The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it the default, but it | |
2297 % works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least evince), the | |
2298 % lilypond developers report. xpdf does work with the regular 0x27. | |
2299 % | |
2300 \def\codequoteright{% | |
2301 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax | |
2302 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax | |
2303 '% | |
2304 \else \char'15 \fi | |
2305 \else \char'15 \fi | |
2306 } | |
2307 % | |
2308 % and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent. | |
2309 % Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like | |
2310 % the code environments to do likewise. | |
2311 % | |
2312 \def\codequoteleft{% | |
2313 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax | |
2314 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax | |
2315 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391 | |
2316 % \relax disables Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font. | |
2317 \relax`% | |
2318 \else \char'22 \fi | |
2319 \else \char'22 \fi | |
2320 } | |
2321 | |
2322 % Commands to set the quote options. | |
2323 % | |
2324 \parseargdef\codequoteundirected{% | |
2325 \def\temp{#1}% | |
2326 \ifx\temp\onword | |
2327 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname | |
2328 = t% | |
2329 \else\ifx\temp\offword | |
2330 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname | |
2331 = \relax | |
2332 \else | |
2333 \errhelp = \EMsimple | |
2334 \errmessage{Unknown @codequoteundirected value `\temp', must be on|off}% | |
2335 \fi\fi | |
2336 } | |
2337 % | |
2338 \parseargdef\codequotebacktick{% | |
2339 \def\temp{#1}% | |
2340 \ifx\temp\onword | |
2341 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname | |
2342 = t% | |
2343 \else\ifx\temp\offword | |
2344 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname | |
2345 = \relax | |
2346 \else | |
2347 \errhelp = \EMsimple | |
2348 \errmessage{Unknown @codequotebacktick value `\temp', must be on|off}% | |
2349 \fi\fi | |
2350 } | |
2351 | |
2352 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391, disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font. | |
2353 \def\noligaturesquoteleft{\relax\lq} | |
2354 | |
2355 % Count depth in font-changes, for error checks | |
2356 \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0 | |
2357 | |
2358 % Font commands. | |
2359 | |
2360 % #1 is the font command (\sl or \it), #2 is the text to slant. | |
2361 % If we are in a monospaced environment, however, 1) always use \ttsl, | |
2362 % and 2) do not add an italic correction. | |
2363 \def\dosmartslant#1#2{% | |
2364 \ifusingtt | |
2365 {{\ttsl #2}\let\next=\relax}% | |
2366 {\def\next{{#1#2}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}}% | |
2367 \next | |
2368 } | |
2369 \def\smartslanted{\dosmartslant\sl} | |
2370 \def\smartitalic{\dosmartslant\it} | |
2371 | |
2372 % Output an italic correction unless \next (presumed to be the following | |
2373 % character) is such as not to need one. | |
2374 \def\smartitaliccorrection{% | |
2375 \ifx\next,% | |
2376 \else\ifx\next-% | |
2377 \else\ifx\next.% | |
2378 \else\ptexslash | |
2379 \fi\fi\fi | |
2380 \aftersmartic | |
2381 } | |
2382 | |
2383 % like \smartslanted except unconditionally uses \ttsl, and no ic. | |
2384 % @var is set to this for defun arguments. | |
2385 \def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}} | |
2386 | |
2387 % @cite is like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want | |
2388 % ttsl for book titles, do we? | |
2389 \def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection} | |
2390 | |
2391 \def\aftersmartic{} | |
2392 \def\var#1{% | |
2393 \let\saveaftersmartic = \aftersmartic | |
2394 \def\aftersmartic{\null\let\aftersmartic=\saveaftersmartic}% | |
2395 \smartslanted{#1}% | |
2396 } | |
2397 | |
2398 \let\i=\smartitalic | |
2399 \let\slanted=\smartslanted | |
2400 \let\dfn=\smartslanted | |
2401 \let\emph=\smartitalic | |
2402 | |
2403 % Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii. | |
2404 \def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font | |
2405 \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font | |
2406 \def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font | |
2407 | |
2408 % @b, explicit bold. Also @strong. | |
2409 \def\b#1{{\bf #1}} | |
2410 \let\strong=\b | |
2411 | |
2412 % @sansserif, explicit sans. | |
2413 \def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}} | |
2414 | |
2415 % We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at | |
2416 % the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the | |
2417 % group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called. | |
2418 % | |
2419 \def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation} | |
2420 \def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- } | |
2421 | |
2422 % Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value. | |
2423 % Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and | |
2424 % sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up. | |
2425 % | |
2426 \catcode`@=11 | |
2427 \def\plainfrenchspacing{% | |
2428 \sfcode\dotChar =\@m \sfcode\questChar=\@m \sfcode\exclamChar=\@m | |
2429 \sfcode\colonChar=\@m \sfcode\semiChar =\@m \sfcode\commaChar =\@m | |
2430 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends | |
2431 } | |
2432 \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{% | |
2433 \sfcode`\.3000\sfcode`\?3000\sfcode`\!3000 | |
2434 \sfcode`\:2000\sfcode`\;1500\sfcode`\,1250 | |
2435 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends | |
2436 } | |
2437 \catcode`@=\other | |
2438 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default | |
2439 | |
2440 % @t, explicit typewriter. | |
2441 \def\t#1{% | |
2442 {\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}% | |
2443 \null | |
2444 } | |
2445 | |
2446 % @samp. | |
2447 \def\samp#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{samp}\lq\tclose{#1}\rq\null}} | |
2448 | |
2449 % definition of @key that produces a lozenge. Doesn't adjust to text size. | |
2450 %\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1} | |
2451 %\font\keysy=cmsy9 | |
2452 %\def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{% | |
2453 % \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{% | |
2454 % \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt | |
2455 % \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}% | |
2456 % \kern-0.4pt\hrule}% | |
2457 % \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}} | |
2458 | |
2459 % definition of @key with no lozenge. If the current font is already | |
2460 % monospace, don't change it; that way, we respect @kbdinputstyle. But | |
2461 % if it isn't monospace, then use \tt. | |
2462 % | |
2463 \def\key#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{key}% | |
2464 \nohyphenation | |
2465 \ifmonospace\else\tt\fi | |
2466 #1}\null} | |
2467 | |
2468 % ctrl is no longer a Texinfo command. | |
2469 \def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1} | |
2470 | |
2471 % @file, @option are the same as @samp. | |
2472 \let\file=\samp | |
2473 \let\option=\samp | |
2474 | |
2475 % @code is a modification of @t, | |
2476 % which makes spaces the same size as normal in the surrounding text. | |
2477 \def\tclose#1{% | |
2478 {% | |
2479 % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font. | |
2480 \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font | |
2481 % | |
2482 % Switch to typewriter. | |
2483 \tt | |
2484 % | |
2485 % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space. | |
2486 \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}% | |
2487 % | |
2488 % Turn off hyphenation. | |
2489 \nohyphenation | |
2490 % | |
2491 \rawbackslash | |
2492 \plainfrenchspacing | |
2493 #1% | |
2494 }% | |
2495 \null % reset spacefactor to 1000 | |
2496 } | |
2497 | |
2498 % We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code. | |
2499 % Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes | |
2500 % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc. | |
2501 | |
2502 % Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control | |
2503 % both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words. | |
2504 % We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that) | |
2505 % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash. | |
2506 % -- rms. | |
2507 { | |
2508 \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active | |
2509 \catcode`\'=\active \catcode`\`=\active | |
2510 \global\let'=\rq \global\let`=\lq % default definitions | |
2511 % | |
2512 \global\def\code{\begingroup | |
2513 \setupmarkupstyle{code}% | |
2514 % The following should really be moved into \setupmarkupstyle handlers. | |
2515 \catcode\dashChar=\active \catcode\underChar=\active | |
2516 \ifallowcodebreaks | |
2517 \let-\codedash | |
2518 \let_\codeunder | |
2519 \else | |
2520 \let-\realdash | |
2521 \let_\realunder | |
2522 \fi | |
2523 \codex | |
2524 } | |
2525 } | |
2526 | |
2527 \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup} | |
2528 | |
2529 \def\realdash{-} | |
2530 \def\codedash{-\discretionary{}{}{}} | |
2531 \def\codeunder{% | |
2532 % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _ | |
2533 % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.) | |
2534 % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us | |
2535 % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop. | |
2536 \ifusingtt{\ifmmode | |
2537 \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_. | |
2538 \else\normalunderscore \fi | |
2539 \discretionary{}{}{}}% | |
2540 {\_}% | |
2541 } | |
2542 | |
2543 % An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g., | |
2544 % each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is undesirable in | |
2545 % some manuals, especially if they don't have long identifiers in | |
2546 % general. @allowcodebreaks provides a way to control this. | |
2547 % | |
2548 \newif\ifallowcodebreaks \allowcodebreakstrue | |
2549 | |
2550 \def\keywordtrue{true} | |
2551 \def\keywordfalse{false} | |
2552 | |
2553 \parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{% | |
2554 \def\txiarg{#1}% | |
2555 \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue | |
2556 \allowcodebreakstrue | |
2557 \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse | |
2558 \allowcodebreaksfalse | |
2559 \else | |
2560 \errhelp = \EMsimple | |
2561 \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `\txiarg', must be true|false}% | |
2562 \fi\fi | |
2563 } | |
2564 | |
2565 % @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional (comma-separated) | |
2566 % second argument specifying the text to display and an optional third | |
2567 % arg as text to display instead of (rather than in addition to) the url | |
2568 % itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url. | |
2569 % (This \urefnobreak definition isn't used now, leaving it for a while | |
2570 % for comparison.) | |
2571 \def\urefnobreak#1{\dourefnobreak #1,,,\finish} | |
2572 \def\dourefnobreak#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{\begingroup | |
2573 \unsepspaces | |
2574 \pdfurl{#1}% | |
2575 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}% | |
2576 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt | |
2577 \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that | |
2578 \else | |
2579 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% | |
2580 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt | |
2581 \ifpdf | |
2582 \unhbox0 % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it | |
2583 \else | |
2584 \unhbox0\ (\code{#1})% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url | |
2585 \fi | |
2586 \else | |
2587 \code{#1}% only url given, so show it | |
2588 \fi | |
2589 \fi | |
2590 \endlink | |
2591 \endgroup} | |
2592 | |
2593 % This \urefbreak definition is the active one. | |
2594 \def\urefbreak{\begingroup \urefcatcodes \dourefbreak} | |
2595 \let\uref=\urefbreak | |
2596 \def\dourefbreak#1{\urefbreakfinish #1,,,\finish} | |
2597 \def\urefbreakfinish#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{% doesn't work in @example | |
2598 \unsepspaces | |
2599 \pdfurl{#1}% | |
2600 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}% | |
2601 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt | |
2602 \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that | |
2603 \else | |
2604 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% | |
2605 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt | |
2606 \ifpdf | |
2607 \unhbox0 % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it | |
2608 \else | |
2609 \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url | |
2610 \fi | |
2611 \else | |
2612 \urefcode{#1}% only url given, so show it | |
2613 \fi | |
2614 \fi | |
2615 \endlink | |
2616 \endgroup} | |
2617 | |
2618 % Allow line breaks around only a few characters (only). | |
2619 \def\urefcatcodes{% | |
2620 \catcode\ampChar=\active \catcode\dotChar=\active | |
2621 \catcode\hashChar=\active \catcode\questChar=\active | |
2622 \catcode\slashChar=\active | |
2623 } | |
2624 { | |
2625 \urefcatcodes | |
2626 % | |
2627 \global\def\urefcode{\begingroup | |
2628 \setupmarkupstyle{code}% | |
2629 \urefcatcodes | |
2630 \let&\urefcodeamp | |
2631 \let.\urefcodedot | |
2632 \let#\urefcodehash | |
2633 \let?\urefcodequest | |
2634 \let/\urefcodeslash | |
2635 \codex | |
2636 } | |
2637 % | |
2638 % By default, they are just regular characters. | |
2639 \global\def&{\normalamp} | |
2640 \global\def.{\normaldot} | |
2641 \global\def#{\normalhash} | |
2642 \global\def?{\normalquest} | |
2643 \global\def/{\normalslash} | |
2644 } | |
2645 | |
2646 % we put a little stretch before and after the breakable chars, to help | |
2647 % line breaking of long url's. The unequal skips make look better in | |
2648 % cmtt at least, especially for dots. | |
2649 \def\urefprestretch{\urefprebreak \hskip0pt plus.13em } | |
2650 \def\urefpoststretch{\urefpostbreak \hskip0pt plus.1em } | |
2651 % | |
2652 \def\urefcodeamp{\urefprestretch \&\urefpoststretch} | |
2653 \def\urefcodedot{\urefprestretch .\urefpoststretch} | |
2654 \def\urefcodehash{\urefprestretch \#\urefpoststretch} | |
2655 \def\urefcodequest{\urefprestretch ?\urefpoststretch} | |
2656 \def\urefcodeslash{\futurelet\next\urefcodeslashfinish} | |
2657 { | |
2658 \catcode`\/=\active | |
2659 \global\def\urefcodeslashfinish{% | |
2660 \urefprestretch \slashChar | |
2661 % Allow line break only after the final / in a sequence of | |
2662 % slashes, to avoid line break between the slashes in http://. | |
2663 \ifx\next/\else \urefpoststretch \fi | |
2664 } | |
2665 } | |
2666 | |
2667 % One more complication: by default we'll break after the special | |
2668 % characters, but some people like to break before the special chars, so | |
2669 % allow that. Also allow no breaking at all, for manual control. | |
2670 % | |
2671 \parseargdef\urefbreakstyle{% | |
2672 \def\txiarg{#1}% | |
2673 \ifx\txiarg\wordnone | |
2674 \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak} | |
2675 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordbefore | |
2676 \def\urefprebreak{\allowbreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak} | |
2677 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordafter | |
2678 \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\allowbreak} | |
2679 \else | |
2680 \errhelp = \EMsimple | |
2681 \errmessage{Unknown @urefbreakstyle setting `\txiarg'}% | |
2682 \fi\fi\fi | |
2683 } | |
2684 \def\wordafter{after} | |
2685 \def\wordbefore{before} | |
2686 \def\wordnone{none} | |
2687 | |
2688 \urefbreakstyle after | |
2689 | |
2690 % @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it. | |
2691 % | |
2692 \let\url=\uref | |
2693 | |
2694 % rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97. | |
2695 % So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf. | |
2696 % | |
2697 %\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright} | |
2698 \ifpdf | |
2699 \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish} | |
2700 \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup | |
2701 \unsepspaces | |
2702 \pdfurl{mailto:#1}% | |
2703 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% | |
2704 \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi | |
2705 \endlink | |
2706 \endgroup} | |
2707 \else | |
2708 \let\email=\uref | |
2709 \fi | |
2710 | |
2711 % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command, | |
2712 % then @kbd has no effect. | |
2713 \def\kbd#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdfoo\look??\par}} | |
2714 | |
2715 % @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always), | |
2716 % `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends), | |
2717 % or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always). | |
2718 \parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{% | |
2719 \def\txiarg{#1}% | |
2720 \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct | |
2721 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}% | |
2722 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample | |
2723 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}% | |
2724 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode | |
2725 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}% | |
2726 \else | |
2727 \errhelp = \EMsimple | |
2728 \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle setting `\txiarg'}% | |
2729 \fi\fi\fi | |
2730 } | |
2731 \def\worddistinct{distinct} | |
2732 \def\wordexample{example} | |
2733 \def\wordcode{code} | |
2734 | |
2735 % Default is `distinct'. | |
2736 \kbdinputstyle distinct | |
2737 | |
2738 \def\xkey{\key} | |
2739 \def\kbdfoo#1#2#3\par{\def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}% | |
2740 \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}% | |
2741 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi | |
2742 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi} | |
2743 | |
2744 % For @indicateurl, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code. | |
2745 \let\indicateurl=\code | |
2746 \let\env=\code | |
2747 \let\command=\code | |
2748 | |
2749 % @clicksequence{File @click{} Open ...} | |
2750 \def\clicksequence#1{\begingroup #1\endgroup} | |
2751 | |
2752 % @clickstyle @arrow (by default) | |
2753 \parseargdef\clickstyle{\def\click{#1}} | |
2754 \def\click{\arrow} | |
2755 | |
2756 % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the | |
2757 % argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt. | |
2758 % | |
2759 \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1} | |
2760 | |
2761 % @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'', | |
2762 % and it is not used as such in any manual I can find. We need it for | |
2763 % Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96. | |
2764 %\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null} | |
2765 | |
2766 % @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like. | |
2767 % We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for | |
2768 % all-uppercase. | |
2769 % | |
2770 \def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish} | |
2771 \def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{% | |
2772 {\selectfonts\lsize #1}% | |
2773 \def\temp{#2}% | |
2774 \ifx\temp\empty \else | |
2775 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})% | |
2776 \fi | |
2777 \null % reset \spacefactor=1000 | |
2778 } | |
2779 | |
2780 % @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like. | |
2781 % No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing. | |
2782 % | |
2783 \def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish} | |
2784 \def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{% | |
2785 {\plainfrenchspacing #1}% | |
2786 \def\temp{#2}% | |
2787 \ifx\temp\empty \else | |
2788 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})% | |
2789 \fi | |
2790 \null % reset \spacefactor=1000 | |
2791 } | |
2792 | |
2793 % @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example. | |
2794 % | |
2795 \def\asis#1{#1} | |
2796 | |
2797 % @math outputs its argument in math mode. | |
2798 % | |
2799 % One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean | |
2800 % an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make | |
2801 % _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam, | |
2802 % which is what @var uses. | |
2803 { | |
2804 \catcode`\_ = \active | |
2805 \gdef\mathunderscore{% | |
2806 \catcode`\_=\active | |
2807 \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}% | |
2808 } | |
2809 } | |
2810 % Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a math (or tt) \. | |
2811 % FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (for no | |
2812 % particular reason), but this is not advertised and we don't care. | |
2813 % | |
2814 % The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\. | |
2815 \def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi} | |
2816 % | |
2817 \def\math{% | |
2818 \tex | |
2819 \mathunderscore | |
2820 \let\\ = \mathbackslash | |
2821 \mathactive | |
2822 % make the texinfo accent commands work in math mode | |
2823 \let\"=\ddot | |
2824 \let\'=\acute | |
2825 \let\==\bar | |
2826 \let\^=\hat | |
2827 \let\`=\grave | |
2828 \let\u=\breve | |
2829 \let\v=\check | |
2830 \let\~=\tilde | |
2831 \let\dotaccent=\dot | |
2832 $\finishmath | |
2833 } | |
2834 \def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex. | |
2835 | |
2836 % Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math. | |
2837 % We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument | |
2838 % to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section). | |
2839 % | |
2840 { | |
2841 \catcode`^ = \active | |
2842 \catcode`< = \active | |
2843 \catcode`> = \active | |
2844 \catcode`+ = \active | |
2845 \catcode`' = \active | |
2846 \gdef\mathactive{% | |
2847 \let^ = \ptexhat | |
2848 \let< = \ptexless | |
2849 \let> = \ptexgtr | |
2850 \let+ = \ptexplus | |
2851 \let' = \ptexquoteright | |
2852 } | |
2853 } | |
2854 | |
2855 % @inlinefmt{FMTNAME,PROCESSED-TEXT} and @inlineraw{FMTNAME,RAW-TEXT}. | |
2856 % Ignore unless FMTNAME == tex; then it is like @iftex and @tex, | |
2857 % except specified as a normal braced arg, so no newlines to worry about. | |
2858 % | |
2859 \def\outfmtnametex{tex} | |
2860 % | |
2861 \long\def\inlinefmt#1{\doinlinefmt #1,\finish} | |
2862 \long\def\doinlinefmt#1,#2,\finish{% | |
2863 \def\inlinefmtname{#1}% | |
2864 \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi | |
2865 } | |
2866 % For raw, must switch into @tex before parsing the argument, to avoid | |
2867 % setting catcodes prematurely. Doing it this way means that, for | |
2868 % example, @inlineraw{html, foo{bar} gets a parse error instead of being | |
2869 % ignored. But this isn't important because if people want a literal | |
2870 % *right* brace they would have to use a command anyway, so they may as | |
2871 % well use a command to get a left brace too. We could re-use the | |
2872 % delimiter character idea from \verb, but it seems like overkill. | |
2873 % | |
2874 \long\def\inlineraw{\tex \doinlineraw} | |
2875 \long\def\doinlineraw#1{\doinlinerawtwo #1,\finish} | |
2876 \def\doinlinerawtwo#1,#2,\finish{% | |
2877 \def\inlinerawname{#1}% | |
2878 \ifx\inlinerawname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi | |
2879 \endgroup % close group opened by \tex. | |
2880 } | |
2881 | |
2882 | |
2883 \message{glyphs,} | |
2884 % and logos. | |
2885 | |
2886 % @@ prints an @, as does @atchar{}. | |
2887 \def\@{\char64 } | |
2888 \let\atchar=\@ | |
2889 | |
2890 % @{ @} @lbracechar{} @rbracechar{} all generate brace characters. | |
2891 % Unless we're in typewriter, use \ecfont because the CM text fonts do | |
2892 % not have braces, and we don't want to switch into math. | |
2893 \def\mylbrace{{\ifmonospace\else\ecfont\fi \char123}} | |
2894 \def\myrbrace{{\ifmonospace\else\ecfont\fi \char125}} | |
2895 \let\{=\mylbrace \let\lbracechar=\{ | |
2896 \let\}=\myrbrace \let\rbracechar=\} | |
2897 \begingroup | |
2898 % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices, | |
2899 % and @{ and @} for the aux/toc files. | |
2900 \catcode`\{ = \other \catcode`\} = \other | |
2901 \catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2 | |
2902 \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \other | |
2903 !gdef!lbracecmd[\{]% | |
2904 !gdef!rbracecmd[\}]% | |
2905 !gdef!lbraceatcmd[@{]% | |
2906 !gdef!rbraceatcmd[@}]% | |
2907 !endgroup | |
2908 | |
2909 % @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems. | |
2910 \let\comma = , | |
2911 | |
2912 % Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent | |
2913 % Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H. | |
2914 \let\, = \ptexc | |
2915 \let\dotaccent = \ptexdot | |
2916 \def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}} | |
2917 \let\tieaccent = \ptext | |
2918 \let\ubaraccent = \ptexb | |
2919 \let\udotaccent = \d | |
2920 | |
2921 % Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm | |
2922 % Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss. | |
2923 \def\questiondown{?`} | |
2924 \def\exclamdown{!`} | |
2925 \def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a}}} | |
2926 \def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o}}} | |
2927 | |
2928 % Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents. | |
2929 \def\imacro{i} | |
2930 \def\jmacro{j} | |
2931 \def\dotless#1{% | |
2932 \def\temp{#1}% | |
2933 \ifx\temp\imacro \ifmmode\imath \else\ptexi \fi | |
2934 \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \ifmmode\jmath \else\j \fi | |
2935 \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}% | |
2936 \fi\fi | |
2937 } | |
2938 | |
2939 % The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a | |
2940 % period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.) | |
2941 % | |
2942 \edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 } | |
2943 | |
2944 % @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in | |
2945 % latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most | |
2946 % convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using | |
2947 % the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and | |
2948 % \scriptscriptstyle). | |
2949 % | |
2950 \def\LaTeX{% | |
2951 L\kern-.36em | |
2952 {\setbox0=\hbox{T}% | |
2953 \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{% | |
2954 \ifx\textnominalsize\xwordpt | |
2955 % for 10pt running text, \lllsize (8pt) is too small for the A in LaTeX. | |
2956 % Revert to plain's \scriptsize, which is 7pt. | |
2957 \count255=\the\fam $\fam\count255 \scriptstyle A$% | |
2958 \else | |
2959 % For 11pt, we can use our lllsize. | |
2960 \selectfonts\lllsize A% | |
2961 \fi | |
2962 }% | |
2963 \vss | |
2964 }}% | |
2965 \kern-.15em | |
2966 \TeX | |
2967 } | |
2968 | |
2969 % Some math mode symbols. | |
2970 \def\bullet{$\ptexbullet$} | |
2971 \def\geq{\ifmmode \ge\else $\ge$\fi} | |
2972 \def\leq{\ifmmode \le\else $\le$\fi} | |
2973 \def\minus{\ifmmode -\else $-$\fi} | |
2974 | |
2975 % @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font. | |
2976 % We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm | |
2977 % typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand, | |
2978 % in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em. So do | |
2979 % whichever is larger. | |
2980 % | |
2981 \def\dots{% | |
2982 \leavevmode | |
2983 \setbox0=\hbox{...}% get width of three periods | |
2984 \ifdim\wd0 > 1.5em | |
2985 \dimen0 = \wd0 | |
2986 \else | |
2987 \dimen0 = 1.5em | |
2988 \fi | |
2989 \hbox to \dimen0{% | |
2990 \hskip 0pt plus.25fil | |
2991 .\hskip 0pt plus1fil | |
2992 .\hskip 0pt plus1fil | |
2993 .\hskip 0pt plus.5fil | |
2994 }% | |
2995 } | |
2996 | |
2997 % @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis. | |
2998 % | |
2999 \def\enddots{% | |
3000 \dots | |
3001 \spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor | |
3002 } | |
3003 | |
3004 % @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}. | |
3005 % | |
3006 % Since these characters are used in examples, they should be an even number of | |
3007 % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em. | |
3008 % | |
3009 \def\point{$\star$} | |
3010 \def\arrow{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\rightarrow$\hfil}} | |
3011 \def\result{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}} | |
3012 \def\expansion{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}} | |
3013 \def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}} | |
3014 \def\equiv{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}} | |
3015 | |
3016 % The @error{} command. | |
3017 % Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit. | |
3018 % | |
3019 \newbox\errorbox | |
3020 % | |
3021 {\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box. | |
3022 \dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules | |
3023 % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.) | |
3024 \setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \reducedsf \putworderror\kern-1.5pt} | |
3025 % | |
3026 \setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil | |
3027 \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right. | |
3028 \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules. | |
3029 \vbox{% | |
3030 \hrule height\dimen2 | |
3031 \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text. | |
3032 \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below. | |
3033 \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right. | |
3034 \hrule height\dimen2} | |
3035 \hfil} | |
3036 % | |
3037 \def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox} | |
3038 | |
3039 % @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font. | |
3040 % | |
3041 \def\pounds{{\it\$}} | |
3042 | |
3043 % @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style. | |
3044 % We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik | |
3045 % Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and | |
3046 % "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need). | |
3047 % It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym. | |
3048 % | |
3049 % Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore | |
3050 % that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular | |
3051 % font height. | |
3052 % | |
3053 % feymr - regular | |
3054 % feymo - slanted | |
3055 % feybr - bold | |
3056 % feybo - bold slanted | |
3057 % | |
3058 % There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge. | |
3059 % A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide. | |
3060 % Hmm. | |
3061 % | |
3062 % Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols? | |
3063 % Hope not. | |
3064 % | |
3065 % | |
3066 \def\euro{{\eurofont e}} | |
3067 \def\eurofont{% | |
3068 % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in | |
3069 % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that | |
3070 % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the | |
3071 % font installed. | |
3072 % | |
3073 % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale | |
3074 % that to the current nominal size. | |
3075 % | |
3076 % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but | |
3077 % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts. | |
3078 % | |
3079 \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}% | |
3080 % | |
3081 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename | |
3082 % bold: | |
3083 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize | |
3084 \else | |
3085 % regular: | |
3086 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize | |
3087 \fi | |
3088 \thiseurofont | |
3089 } | |
3090 | |
3091 % Glyphs from the EC fonts. We don't use \let for the aliases, because | |
3092 % sometimes we redefine the original macro, and the alias should reflect | |
3093 % the redefinition. | |
3094 % | |
3095 % Use LaTeX names for the Icelandic letters. | |
3096 \def\DH{{\ecfont \char"D0}} % Eth | |
3097 \def\dh{{\ecfont \char"F0}} % eth | |
3098 \def\TH{{\ecfont \char"DE}} % Thorn | |
3099 \def\th{{\ecfont \char"FE}} % thorn | |
3100 % | |
3101 \def\guillemetleft{{\ecfont \char"13}} | |
3102 \def\guillemotleft{\guillemetleft} | |
3103 \def\guillemetright{{\ecfont \char"14}} | |
3104 \def\guillemotright{\guillemetright} | |
3105 \def\guilsinglleft{{\ecfont \char"0E}} | |
3106 \def\guilsinglright{{\ecfont \char"0F}} | |
3107 \def\quotedblbase{{\ecfont \char"12}} | |
3108 \def\quotesinglbase{{\ecfont \char"0D}} | |
3109 % | |
3110 % This positioning is not perfect (see the ogonek LaTeX package), but | |
3111 % we have the precomposed glyphs for the most common cases. We put the | |
3112 % tests to use those glyphs in the single \ogonek macro so we have fewer | |
3113 % dummy definitions to worry about for index entries, etc. | |
3114 % | |
3115 % ogonek is also used with other letters in Lithuanian (IOU), but using | |
3116 % the precomposed glyphs for those is not so easy since they aren't in | |
3117 % the same EC font. | |
3118 \def\ogonek#1{{% | |
3119 \def\temp{#1}% | |
3120 \ifx\temp\macrocharA\Aogonek | |
3121 \else\ifx\temp\macrochara\aogonek | |
3122 \else\ifx\temp\macrocharE\Eogonek | |
3123 \else\ifx\temp\macrochare\eogonek | |
3124 \else | |
3125 \ecfont \setbox0=\hbox{#1}% | |
3126 \ifdim\ht0=1ex\accent"0C #1% | |
3127 \else\ooalign{\unhbox0\crcr\hidewidth\char"0C \hidewidth}% | |
3128 \fi | |
3129 \fi\fi\fi\fi | |
3130 }% | |
3131 } | |
3132 \def\Aogonek{{\ecfont \char"81}}\def\macrocharA{A} | |
3133 \def\aogonek{{\ecfont \char"A1}}\def\macrochara{a} | |
3134 \def\Eogonek{{\ecfont \char"86}}\def\macrocharE{E} | |
3135 \def\eogonek{{\ecfont \char"A6}}\def\macrochare{e} | |
3136 % | |
3137 % Use the ec* fonts (cm-super in outline format) for non-CM glyphs. | |
3138 \def\ecfont{% | |
3139 % We can't distinguish serif/sans and italic/slanted, but this | |
3140 % is used for crude hacks anyway (like adding French and German | |
3141 % quotes to documents typeset with CM, where we lose kerning), so | |
3142 % hopefully nobody will notice/care. | |
3143 \edef\ecsize{\csname\curfontsize ecsize\endcsname}% | |
3144 \edef\nominalsize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}% | |
3145 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename | |
3146 % bold: | |
3147 \font\thisecfont = ecb\ifusingit{i}{x}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize | |
3148 \else | |
3149 % regular: | |
3150 \font\thisecfont = ec\ifusingit{ti}{rm}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize | |
3151 \fi | |
3152 \thisecfont | |
3153 } | |
3154 | |
3155 % @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really | |
3156 % be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now. | |
3157 % Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright. | |
3158 % | |
3159 \def\registeredsymbol{% | |
3160 $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize R}% | |
3161 \hfil\crcr\Orb}}% | |
3162 }$% | |
3163 } | |
3164 | |
3165 % @textdegree - the normal degrees sign. | |
3166 % | |
3167 \def\textdegree{$^\circ$} | |
3168 | |
3169 % Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with: | |
3170 % Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38 | |
3171 % so we'll define it if necessary. | |
3172 % | |
3173 \ifx\Orb\thisisundefined | |
3174 \def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D} | |
3175 \fi | |
3176 | |
3177 % Quotes. | |
3178 \chardef\quotedblleft="5C | |
3179 \chardef\quotedblright=`\" | |
3180 \chardef\quoteleft=`\` | |
3181 \chardef\quoteright=`\' | |
3182 | |
3183 | |
3184 \message{page headings,} | |
3185 | |
3186 \newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in | |
3187 \newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc | |
3188 | |
3189 % First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage. | |
3190 \newif\ifseenauthor | |
3191 \newif\iffinishedtitlepage | |
3192 | |
3193 % Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the | |
3194 % user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage. | |
3195 % | |
3196 \newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage | |
3197 \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage = \setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue | |
3198 \newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage | |
3199 \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue | |
3200 | |
3201 \parseargdef\shorttitlepage{% | |
3202 \begingroup \hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}% | |
3203 \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page} | |
3204 | |
3205 \envdef\titlepage{% | |
3206 % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage. | |
3207 \begingroup | |
3208 \parindent=0pt \textfonts | |
3209 % Leave some space at the very top of the page. | |
3210 \vglue\titlepagetopglue | |
3211 % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title. | |
3212 \finishedtitlepagetrue | |
3213 % | |
3214 % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space | |
3215 % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second. | |
3216 \let\oldpage = \page | |
3217 \def\page{% | |
3218 \iffinishedtitlepage\else | |
3219 \finishtitlepage | |
3220 \fi | |
3221 \let\page = \oldpage | |
3222 \page | |
3223 \null | |
3224 }% | |
3225 } | |
3226 | |
3227 \def\Etitlepage{% | |
3228 \iffinishedtitlepage\else | |
3229 \finishtitlepage | |
3230 \fi | |
3231 % It is important to do the page break before ending the group, | |
3232 % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group. | |
3233 % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page | |
3234 % after the title page, which we certainly don't want. | |
3235 \oldpage | |
3236 \endgroup | |
3237 % | |
3238 % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are | |
3239 % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers. | |
3240 \HEADINGSon | |
3241 % | |
3242 % If they want short, they certainly want long too. | |
3243 \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage | |
3244 \shortcontents | |
3245 \contents | |
3246 \global\let\shortcontents = \relax | |
3247 \global\let\contents = \relax | |
3248 \fi | |
3249 % | |
3250 \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage | |
3251 \contents | |
3252 \global\let\contents = \relax | |
3253 \global\let\shortcontents = \relax | |
3254 \fi | |
3255 } | |
3256 | |
3257 \def\finishtitlepage{% | |
3258 \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize | |
3259 \vskip\titlepagebottomglue | |
3260 \finishedtitlepagetrue | |
3261 } | |
3262 | |
3263 % Macros to be used within @titlepage: | |
3264 | |
3265 \let\subtitlerm=\tenrm | |
3266 \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines} | |
3267 | |
3268 \parseargdef\title{% | |
3269 \checkenv\titlepage | |
3270 \leftline{\titlefonts\rmisbold #1} | |
3271 % print a rule at the page bottom also. | |
3272 \finishedtitlepagefalse | |
3273 \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt | |
3274 } | |
3275 | |
3276 \parseargdef\subtitle{% | |
3277 \checkenv\titlepage | |
3278 {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}% | |
3279 } | |
3280 | |
3281 % @author should come last, but may come many times. | |
3282 % It can also be used inside @quotation. | |
3283 % | |
3284 \parseargdef\author{% | |
3285 \def\temp{\quotation}% | |
3286 \ifx\thisenv\temp | |
3287 \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation. | |
3288 \else | |
3289 \checkenv\titlepage | |
3290 \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi | |
3291 {\secfonts\rmisbold \leftline{#1}}% | |
3292 \fi | |
3293 } | |
3294 | |
3295 | |
3296 % Set up page headings and footings. | |
3297 | |
3298 \let\thispage=\folio | |
3299 | |
3300 \newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages | |
3301 \newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages | |
3302 \newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages | |
3303 \newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages | |
3304 | |
3305 % Now make TeX use those variables | |
3306 \headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline | |
3307 \else \the\evenheadline \fi}} | |
3308 \footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline | |
3309 \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook} | |
3310 \let\HEADINGShook=\relax | |
3311 | |
3312 % Commands to set those variables. | |
3313 % For example, this is what @headings on does | |
3314 % @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter | |
3315 % @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle | |
3316 % @evenfooting @thisfile|| | |
3317 % @oddfooting ||@thisfile | |
3318 | |
3319 | |
3320 \def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx} | |
3321 \def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} | |
3322 \def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% | |
3323 \global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} | |
3324 | |
3325 \def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx} | |
3326 \def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} | |
3327 \def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% | |
3328 \global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} | |
3329 | |
3330 \parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}% | |
3331 | |
3332 \def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx} | |
3333 \def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} | |
3334 \def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% | |
3335 \global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} | |
3336 | |
3337 \def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx} | |
3338 \def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} | |
3339 \def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% | |
3340 \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}% | |
3341 % | |
3342 % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume | |
3343 % @evenfooting will not be used by itself. | |
3344 \global\advance\pageheight by -12pt | |
3345 \global\advance\vsize by -12pt | |
3346 } | |
3347 | |
3348 \parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}} | |
3349 | |
3350 % @evenheadingmarks top \thischapter <- chapter at the top of a page | |
3351 % @evenheadingmarks bottom \thischapter <- chapter at the bottom of a page | |
3352 % | |
3353 % The same set of arguments for: | |
3354 % | |
3355 % @oddheadingmarks | |
3356 % @evenfootingmarks | |
3357 % @oddfootingmarks | |
3358 % @everyheadingmarks | |
3359 % @everyfootingmarks | |
3360 | |
3361 \def\evenheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{heading}} | |
3362 \def\oddheadingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{heading}} | |
3363 \def\evenfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{footing}} | |
3364 \def\oddfootingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{footing}} | |
3365 \def\everyheadingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{heading}{#1} | |
3366 \headingmarks{odd}{heading}{#1} } | |
3367 \def\everyfootingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{footing}{#1} | |
3368 \headingmarks{odd}{footing}{#1} } | |
3369 % #1 = even/odd, #2 = heading/footing, #3 = top/bottom. | |
3370 \def\headingmarks#1#2#3 {% | |
3371 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp \csname get#3headingmarks\endcsname | |
3372 \global\expandafter\let\csname get#1#2marks\endcsname \temp | |
3373 } | |
3374 | |
3375 \everyheadingmarks bottom | |
3376 \everyfootingmarks bottom | |
3377 | |
3378 % @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing. | |
3379 % @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing. | |
3380 % @headings off turns them off. | |
3381 % @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility. | |
3382 % @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page. | |
3383 % @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page. | |
3384 % @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page. | |
3385 % By default, they are off at the start of a document, | |
3386 % and turned `on' after @end titlepage. | |
3387 | |
3388 \def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname} | |
3389 | |
3390 \def\headingsoff{% non-global headings elimination | |
3391 \evenheadline={\hfil}\evenfootline={\hfil}% | |
3392 \oddheadline={\hfil}\oddfootline={\hfil}% | |
3393 } | |
3394 | |
3395 \def\HEADINGSoff{{\globaldefs=1 \headingsoff}} % global setting | |
3396 \HEADINGSoff % it's the default | |
3397 | |
3398 % When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1. | |
3399 % For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner, | |
3400 % chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document | |
3401 % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top | |
3402 % edge of all pages. | |
3403 \def\HEADINGSdouble{% | |
3404 \global\pageno=1 | |
3405 \global\evenfootline={\hfil} | |
3406 \global\oddfootline={\hfil} | |
3407 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}} | |
3408 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} | |
3409 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage | |
3410 } | |
3411 \let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager | |
3412 | |
3413 % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page, | |
3414 % page number on top right. | |
3415 \def\HEADINGSsingle{% | |
3416 \global\pageno=1 | |
3417 \global\evenfootline={\hfil} | |
3418 \global\oddfootline={\hfil} | |
3419 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} | |
3420 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} | |
3421 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager | |
3422 } | |
3423 \def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble} | |
3424 | |
3425 \def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex} | |
3426 \let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter | |
3427 \def\HEADINGSdoublex{% | |
3428 \global\evenfootline={\hfil} | |
3429 \global\oddfootline={\hfil} | |
3430 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}} | |
3431 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} | |
3432 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage | |
3433 } | |
3434 | |
3435 \def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex} | |
3436 \def\HEADINGSsinglex{% | |
3437 \global\evenfootline={\hfil} | |
3438 \global\oddfootline={\hfil} | |
3439 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} | |
3440 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} | |
3441 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager | |
3442 } | |
3443 | |
3444 % Subroutines used in generating headings | |
3445 % This produces Day Month Year style of output. | |
3446 % Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set | |
3447 % up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this). | |
3448 \ifx\today\thisisundefined | |
3449 \def\today{% | |
3450 \number\day\space | |
3451 \ifcase\month | |
3452 \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr | |
3453 \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug | |
3454 \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec | |
3455 \fi | |
3456 \space\number\year} | |
3457 \fi | |
3458 | |
3459 % @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings. | |
3460 % It generates no output of its own. | |
3461 \def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle} | |
3462 \def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}} | |
3463 | |
3464 | |
3465 \message{tables,} | |
3466 % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x). | |
3467 | |
3468 % default indentation of table text | |
3469 \newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in | |
3470 % default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text | |
3471 \newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=.3in | |
3472 % margin between end of table item and start of table text. | |
3473 \newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=.1in | |
3474 | |
3475 % used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin | |
3476 \newdimen\itemmax | |
3477 | |
3478 % Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with | |
3479 % these defs. | |
3480 % They also define \itemindex | |
3481 % to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none). | |
3482 | |
3483 \newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip | |
3484 | |
3485 \def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi} | |
3486 | |
3487 \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz} | |
3488 \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz} | |
3489 | |
3490 \def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup % | |
3491 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip | |
3492 \advance\hsize by -\tableindent | |
3493 \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}% | |
3494 \itemindex{#1}% | |
3495 \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx. | |
3496 % | |
3497 % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line | |
3498 % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that | |
3499 % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next | |
3500 % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the | |
3501 % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space. | |
3502 \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax | |
3503 % | |
3504 % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping, | |
3505 % but leave it ragged-right. | |
3506 \begingroup | |
3507 \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent | |
3508 \advance\hsize by\tableindent | |
3509 \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil\relax | |
3510 \leavevmode\unhbox0\par | |
3511 \endgroup | |
3512 % | |
3513 % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the | |
3514 % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started. | |
3515 \nobreak \vskip-\parskip | |
3516 % | |
3517 % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if | |
3518 % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no | |
3519 % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would | |
3520 % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this | |
3521 % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert | |
3522 % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also. | |
3523 % | |
3524 \penalty 10001 | |
3525 \endgroup | |
3526 \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse | |
3527 \else | |
3528 % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the | |
3529 % following text (if any) will end up on the same line. | |
3530 \noindent | |
3531 % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in | |
3532 % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and | |
3533 % eventually be printed. | |
3534 \nobreak\kern-\tableindent | |
3535 \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 | |
3536 \unhbox0 | |
3537 \nobreak\kern\dimen0 | |
3538 \endgroup | |
3539 \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue | |
3540 \fi | |
3541 } | |
3542 | |
3543 \def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment}} | |
3544 \def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment}} | |
3545 | |
3546 % @table, @ftable, @vtable. | |
3547 \envdef\table{% | |
3548 \let\itemindex\gobble | |
3549 \tablecheck{table}% | |
3550 } | |
3551 \envdef\ftable{% | |
3552 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}% | |
3553 \tablecheck{ftable}% | |
3554 } | |
3555 \envdef\vtable{% | |
3556 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}% | |
3557 \tablecheck{vtable}% | |
3558 } | |
3559 \def\tablecheck#1{% | |
3560 \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=\active | |
3561 \endgroup | |
3562 \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is | |
3563 that we are \inenvironment\thisenv}% | |
3564 \def\next{\doignore{#1}}% | |
3565 \else | |
3566 \let\next\tablex | |
3567 \fi | |
3568 \next | |
3569 } | |
3570 \def\tablex#1{% | |
3571 \def\itemindicate{#1}% | |
3572 \parsearg\tabley | |
3573 } | |
3574 \def\tabley#1{% | |
3575 {% | |
3576 \makevalueexpandable | |
3577 \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}% | |
3578 \expandafter | |
3579 }\temp \endtablez | |
3580 } | |
3581 \def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{% | |
3582 \aboveenvbreak | |
3583 \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi | |
3584 \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi | |
3585 \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi | |
3586 \itemmax=\tableindent | |
3587 \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin | |
3588 \advance \leftskip by \tableindent | |
3589 \exdentamount=\tableindent | |
3590 \parindent = 0pt | |
3591 \parskip = \smallskipamount | |
3592 \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi | |
3593 \let\item = \internalBitem | |
3594 \let\itemx = \internalBitemx | |
3595 } | |
3596 \def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak} | |
3597 \let\Eftable\Etable | |
3598 \let\Evtable\Etable | |
3599 \let\Eitemize\Etable | |
3600 \let\Eenumerate\Etable | |
3601 | |
3602 % This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize | |
3603 | |
3604 \newcount \itemno | |
3605 | |
3606 \envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize} | |
3607 | |
3608 \def\doitemize#1{% | |
3609 \aboveenvbreak | |
3610 \itemmax=\itemindent | |
3611 \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin | |
3612 \advance\leftskip by \itemindent | |
3613 \exdentamount=\itemindent | |
3614 \parindent=0pt | |
3615 \parskip=\smallskipamount | |
3616 \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi | |
3617 % | |
3618 % Try typesetting the item mark that if the document erroneously says | |
3619 % something like @itemize @samp (intending @table), there's an error | |
3620 % right away at the @itemize. It's not the best error message in the | |
3621 % world, but it's better than leaving it to the @item. This means if | |
3622 % the user wants an empty mark, they have to say @w{} not just @w. | |
3623 \def\itemcontents{#1}% | |
3624 \setbox0 = \hbox{\itemcontents}% | |
3625 % | |
3626 % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet. | |
3627 \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi | |
3628 % | |
3629 \let\item=\itemizeitem | |
3630 } | |
3631 | |
3632 % Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate. | |
3633 % | |
3634 \def\itemizeitem{% | |
3635 \advance\itemno by 1 % for enumerations | |
3636 {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break | |
3637 {% | |
3638 % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a | |
3639 % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have | |
3640 % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero | |
3641 % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the | |
3642 % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there | |
3643 % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much | |
3644 % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least | |
3645 % that's the theory. | |
3646 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi | |
3647 \noindent | |
3648 \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}% | |
3649 % | |
3650 \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% not good to break after first line of item. | |
3651 \flushcr | |
3652 } | |
3653 | |
3654 % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in | |
3655 % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder. | |
3656 % | |
3657 \def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}% | |
3658 | |
3659 % Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter, | |
3660 % or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No | |
3661 % argument is the same as `1'. | |
3662 % | |
3663 \envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey} | |
3664 \def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{% | |
3665 % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'. | |
3666 \def\thearg{#1}% | |
3667 \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi | |
3668 % | |
3669 % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a | |
3670 % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number. | |
3671 % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made. | |
3672 % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at | |
3673 % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.) | |
3674 \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark | |
3675 \ifx\rest\empty | |
3676 % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything. | |
3677 % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero. | |
3678 % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and | |
3679 % not equal to itself. | |
3680 % Otherwise, we assume it's a number. | |
3681 % | |
3682 % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from | |
3683 % continuing to look for a <number>. | |
3684 % | |
3685 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax | |
3686 \numericenumerate % a number (we hope) | |
3687 \else | |
3688 % It's a letter. | |
3689 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax | |
3690 \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter | |
3691 \else | |
3692 \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter | |
3693 \fi | |
3694 \fi | |
3695 \else | |
3696 % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number. | |
3697 \numericenumerate | |
3698 \fi | |
3699 } | |
3700 | |
3701 % An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is | |
3702 % given in \thearg. | |
3703 % | |
3704 \def\numericenumerate{% | |
3705 \itemno = \thearg | |
3706 \startenumeration{\the\itemno}% | |
3707 } | |
3708 | |
3709 % The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg. | |
3710 \def\lowercaseenumerate{% | |
3711 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg | |
3712 \startenumeration{% | |
3713 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet. | |
3714 \ifnum\itemno=0 | |
3715 \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger | |
3716 alphabet}% | |
3717 \fi | |
3718 \char\lccode\itemno | |
3719 }% | |
3720 } | |
3721 | |
3722 % The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg. | |
3723 \def\uppercaseenumerate{% | |
3724 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg | |
3725 \startenumeration{% | |
3726 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet. | |
3727 \ifnum\itemno=0 | |
3728 \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger | |
3729 alphabet} | |
3730 \fi | |
3731 \char\uccode\itemno | |
3732 }% | |
3733 } | |
3734 | |
3735 % Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the | |
3736 % common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in | |
3737 % \itemno, since @item increments \itemno. | |
3738 % | |
3739 \def\startenumeration#1{% | |
3740 \advance\itemno by -1 | |
3741 \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr | |
3742 } | |
3743 | |
3744 % @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg | |
3745 % to @enumerate. | |
3746 % | |
3747 \def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}} | |
3748 \def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}} | |
3749 \def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate} | |
3750 \def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate} | |
3751 | |
3752 | |
3753 % @multitable macros | |
3754 % Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96 | |
3755 % | |
3756 % @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired. | |
3757 % Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width | |
3758 % can be specified either with sample text given in a template line, | |
3759 % or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page. | |
3760 | |
3761 % Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines. | |
3762 | |
3763 % To make preamble: | |
3764 % | |
3765 % Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize: | |
3766 % @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45 | |
3767 % @item ... | |
3768 % | |
3769 % Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total | |
3770 % current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many | |
3771 % columns as desired. | |
3772 | |
3773 | |
3774 % Or use a template: | |
3775 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template} | |
3776 % @item ... | |
3777 % using the widest term desired in each column. | |
3778 | |
3779 % Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column | |
3780 % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's | |
3781 % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed, | |
3782 % ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns. | |
3783 | |
3784 % @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt | |
3785 % if they are. | |
3786 | |
3787 % Sample multitable: | |
3788 | |
3789 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template} | |
3790 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col | |
3791 % @item | |
3792 % first col stuff | |
3793 % @tab | |
3794 % second col stuff | |
3795 % @tab | |
3796 % third col | |
3797 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff | |
3798 % @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column. | |
3799 % | |
3800 % They will wrap at the width determined by the template. | |
3801 % @item@tab@tab This will be in third column. | |
3802 % @end multitable | |
3803 | |
3804 % Default dimensions may be reset by user. | |
3805 % @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table. | |
3806 % @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table. | |
3807 % @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns. | |
3808 % @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline | |
3809 % to baseline. | |
3810 % 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing. | |
3811 % | |
3812 \newskip\multitableparskip | |
3813 \newskip\multitableparindent | |
3814 \newdimen\multitablecolspace | |
3815 \newskip\multitablelinespace | |
3816 \multitableparskip=0pt | |
3817 \multitableparindent=6pt | |
3818 \multitablecolspace=12pt | |
3819 \multitablelinespace=0pt | |
3820 | |
3821 % Macros used to set up halign preamble: | |
3822 % | |
3823 \let\endsetuptable\relax | |
3824 \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable} | |
3825 \let\columnfractions\relax | |
3826 \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions} | |
3827 \newif\ifsetpercent | |
3828 | |
3829 % #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might | |
3830 % be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is. | |
3831 % | |
3832 \def\pickupwholefraction#1 {% | |
3833 \global\advance\colcount by 1 | |
3834 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}% | |
3835 \setuptable | |
3836 } | |
3837 | |
3838 \newcount\colcount | |
3839 \def\setuptable#1{% | |
3840 \def\firstarg{#1}% | |
3841 \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable | |
3842 \let\go = \relax | |
3843 \else | |
3844 \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions | |
3845 \global\setpercenttrue | |
3846 \else | |
3847 \ifsetpercent | |
3848 \let\go\pickupwholefraction | |
3849 \else | |
3850 \global\advance\colcount by 1 | |
3851 \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a | |
3852 % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway. | |
3853 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}% | |
3854 \fi | |
3855 \fi | |
3856 \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction | |
3857 % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so | |
3858 % we'll always have a period there to be parsed. | |
3859 \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}% | |
3860 \else | |
3861 \let\go = \setuptable | |
3862 \fi% | |
3863 \fi | |
3864 \go | |
3865 } | |
3866 | |
3867 % multitable-only commands. | |
3868 % | |
3869 % @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold. | |
3870 % Assignments have to be global since we are inside the implicit group | |
3871 % of an alignment entry. \everycr resets \everytab so we don't have to | |
3872 % undo it ourselves. | |
3873 \def\headitemfont{\b}% for people to use in the template row; not changeable | |
3874 \def\headitem{% | |
3875 \checkenv\multitable | |
3876 \crcr | |
3877 \global\everytab={\bf}% can't use \headitemfont since the parsing differs | |
3878 \the\everytab % for the first item | |
3879 }% | |
3880 % | |
3881 % A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template | |
3882 % line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until | |
3883 % we again encounter the problem the 1sp was intended to solve. | |
3884 % --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99. | |
3885 \def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}% | |
3886 | |
3887 % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions: | |
3888 % | |
3889 \newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab. | |
3890 % | |
3891 \envdef\multitable{% | |
3892 \vskip\parskip | |
3893 \startsavinginserts | |
3894 % | |
3895 % @item within a multitable starts a normal row. | |
3896 % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries | |
3897 % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka | |
3898 % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize. | |
3899 \def\item{\crcr}% | |
3900 % | |
3901 \tolerance=9500 | |
3902 \hbadness=9500 | |
3903 \setmultitablespacing | |
3904 \parskip=\multitableparskip | |
3905 \parindent=\multitableparindent | |
3906 \overfullrule=0pt | |
3907 \global\colcount=0 | |
3908 % | |
3909 \everycr = {% | |
3910 \noalign{% | |
3911 \global\everytab={}% | |
3912 \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter. | |
3913 % Check for saved footnotes, etc. | |
3914 \checkinserts | |
3915 % Keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages. | |
3916 %\filbreak | |
3917 % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the | |
3918 % table breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better? Wait until the | |
3919 % problem manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl. | |
3920 }% | |
3921 }% | |
3922 % | |
3923 \parsearg\domultitable | |
3924 } | |
3925 \def\domultitable#1{% | |
3926 % To parse everything between @multitable and @item: | |
3927 \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable | |
3928 % | |
3929 % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will | |
3930 % be used as many times as user calls for columns. | |
3931 % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and | |
3932 % continue for many paragraphs if desired. | |
3933 \halign\bgroup &% | |
3934 \global\advance\colcount by 1 | |
3935 \multistrut | |
3936 \vtop{% | |
3937 % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width: | |
3938 \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname | |
3939 % | |
3940 % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other | |
3941 % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after | |
3942 % the first one. | |
3943 % | |
3944 % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace | |
3945 % to the width of each template entry. | |
3946 % | |
3947 % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will | |
3948 % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip | |
3949 % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at | |
3950 % left margin and final column will justify at right margin. | |
3951 % | |
3952 % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment. | |
3953 \rightskip=0pt | |
3954 \ifnum\colcount=1 | |
3955 % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text. | |
3956 \advance\hsize by\leftskip | |
3957 \else | |
3958 \ifsetpercent \else | |
3959 % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize | |
3960 % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace. | |
3961 \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace | |
3962 \fi | |
3963 % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace: | |
3964 \leftskip=\multitablecolspace | |
3965 \fi | |
3966 % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious | |
3967 % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the | |
3968 % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself. | |
3969 % For example: | |
3970 % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89 | |
3971 % @item @code{#} | |
3972 % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country. | |
3973 % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively | |
3974 % marking characters. | |
3975 \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut | |
3976 }\cr | |
3977 } | |
3978 \def\Emultitable{% | |
3979 \crcr | |
3980 \egroup % end the \halign | |
3981 \global\setpercentfalse | |
3982 } | |
3983 | |
3984 \def\setmultitablespacing{% | |
3985 \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing | |
3986 % | |
3987 % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in | |
3988 % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on | |
3989 % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off. | |
3990 % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100. | |
3991 \ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt | |
3992 \setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip | |
3993 \global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0 | |
3994 \fi | |
3995 % Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of | |
3996 % table. If not, do nothing. | |
3997 % If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace. | |
3998 \ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace | |
3999 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace | |
4000 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller | |
4001 % than skip between lines in the table. | |
4002 \fi% | |
4003 \ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt | |
4004 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace | |
4005 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller | |
4006 % than skip between lines in the table. | |
4007 \fi} | |
4008 | |
4009 | |
4010 \message{conditionals,} | |
4011 | |
4012 % @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext, | |
4013 % @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't | |
4014 % attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we | |
4015 % have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't | |
4016 % attempt to close an environment group. | |
4017 % | |
4018 \def\makecond#1{% | |
4019 \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax | |
4020 \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1 | |
4021 } | |
4022 \makecond{iftex} | |
4023 \makecond{ifnotdocbook} | |
4024 \makecond{ifnothtml} | |
4025 \makecond{ifnotinfo} | |
4026 \makecond{ifnotplaintext} | |
4027 \makecond{ifnotxml} | |
4028 | |
4029 % Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like. | |
4030 % | |
4031 \def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}} | |
4032 \def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}} | |
4033 \def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}} | |
4034 \def\html{\doignore{html}} | |
4035 \def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}} | |
4036 \def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}} | |
4037 \def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}} | |
4038 \def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}} | |
4039 \def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}} | |
4040 \def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}} | |
4041 \def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}} | |
4042 \def\menu{\doignore{menu}} | |
4043 \def\xml{\doignore{xml}} | |
4044 | |
4045 % Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals. | |
4046 % | |
4047 % A count to remember the depth of nesting. | |
4048 \newcount\doignorecount | |
4049 | |
4050 \def\doignore#1{\begingroup | |
4051 % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode: | |
4052 \obeylines | |
4053 \catcode`\@ = \other | |
4054 \catcode`\{ = \other | |
4055 \catcode`\} = \other | |
4056 % | |
4057 % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants. | |
4058 \spaceisspace | |
4059 % | |
4060 % Count number of #1's that we've seen. | |
4061 \doignorecount = 0 | |
4062 % | |
4063 % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'. | |
4064 \dodoignore{#1}% | |
4065 } | |
4066 | |
4067 { \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source. | |
4068 \obeylines % | |
4069 % | |
4070 \gdef\dodoignore#1{% | |
4071 % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'. | |
4072 % | |
4073 % Define a command to find the next `@end #1'. | |
4074 \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M@end #1{% | |
4075 \doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1\_STOP_}% | |
4076 % | |
4077 % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a | |
4078 % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for | |
4079 % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.) | |
4080 \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}% | |
4081 % | |
4082 % And now expand that command. | |
4083 \doignoretext ^^M% | |
4084 }% | |
4085 } | |
4086 | |
4087 \def\doignoreyyy#1{% | |
4088 \def\temp{#1}% | |
4089 \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found. | |
4090 \let\next\doignoretextzzz | |
4091 \else % Found a nested condition, ... | |
4092 \advance\doignorecount by 1 | |
4093 \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another. | |
4094 % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example). | |
4095 \fi | |
4096 \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro. | |
4097 } | |
4098 | |
4099 % We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_". | |
4100 % | |
4101 \def\doignoretextzzz#1{% | |
4102 \ifnum\doignorecount = 0 % We have just found the outermost @end. | |
4103 \let\next\enddoignore | |
4104 \else % Still inside a nested condition. | |
4105 \advance\doignorecount by -1 | |
4106 \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end. | |
4107 \fi | |
4108 \next | |
4109 } | |
4110 | |
4111 % Finish off ignored text. | |
4112 { \obeylines% | |
4113 % Ignore anything after the last `@end #1'; this matters in verbatim | |
4114 % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional | |
4115 % would result in a blank line in the output. | |
4116 \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M{\endgroup\ignorespaces}% | |
4117 } | |
4118 | |
4119 | |
4120 % @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value. | |
4121 % @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE. | |
4122 % | |
4123 % Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be | |
4124 % empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our | |
4125 % own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we | |
4126 % didn't need it. | |
4127 % We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10. | |
4128 % | |
4129 \parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy} | |
4130 \def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{% | |
4131 {% | |
4132 \makevalueexpandable | |
4133 \def\temp{#2}% | |
4134 \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}% | |
4135 \ifx\temp\empty | |
4136 \next{}% | |
4137 \else | |
4138 \setzzz#2\endsetzzz | |
4139 \fi | |
4140 }% | |
4141 } | |
4142 % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted. | |
4143 \def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}} | |
4144 | |
4145 % @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR. | |
4146 % | |
4147 \parseargdef\clear{% | |
4148 {% | |
4149 \makevalueexpandable | |
4150 \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax | |
4151 }% | |
4152 } | |
4153 | |
4154 % @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo. | |
4155 \def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx} | |
4156 \def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup} | |
4157 { | |
4158 \catcode`\- = \active \catcode`\_ = \active | |
4159 % | |
4160 \gdef\makevalueexpandable{% | |
4161 \let\value = \expandablevalue | |
4162 % We don't want these characters active, ... | |
4163 \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other | |
4164 % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if | |
4165 % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though. | |
4166 % So \let them to their normal equivalents. | |
4167 \let-\realdash \let_\normalunderscore | |
4168 } | |
4169 } | |
4170 | |
4171 % We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's | |
4172 % properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies). | |
4173 % The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since | |
4174 % the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the | |
4175 % variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain | |
4176 % it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work | |
4177 % to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete). | |
4178 % | |
4179 \def\expandablevalue#1{% | |
4180 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax | |
4181 {[No value for ``#1'']}% | |
4182 \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}% | |
4183 \else | |
4184 \csname SET#1\endcsname | |
4185 \fi | |
4186 } | |
4187 | |
4188 % @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined | |
4189 % with @set. | |
4190 % | |
4191 % To get special treatment of `@end ifset,' call \makeond and the redefine. | |
4192 % | |
4193 \makecond{ifset} | |
4194 \def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}} | |
4195 \def\doifset#1#2{% | |
4196 {% | |
4197 \makevalueexpandable | |
4198 \let\next=\empty | |
4199 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax | |
4200 #1% If not set, redefine \next. | |
4201 \fi | |
4202 \expandafter | |
4203 }\next | |
4204 } | |
4205 \def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}} | |
4206 | |
4207 % @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been | |
4208 % defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear. | |
4209 % | |
4210 % The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the | |
4211 % above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set, | |
4212 % then redefine \next to \ifclearfail. | |
4213 % | |
4214 \makecond{ifclear} | |
4215 \def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}} | |
4216 \def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}} | |
4217 | |
4218 % @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file | |
4219 % which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX. | |
4220 \let\dircategory=\comment | |
4221 | |
4222 % @defininfoenclose. | |
4223 \let\definfoenclose=\comment | |
4224 | |
4225 | |
4226 \message{indexing,} | |
4227 % Index generation facilities | |
4228 | |
4229 % Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite | |
4230 % except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's. | |
4231 \edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}} | |
4232 | |
4233 % \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo. | |
4234 % It automatically defines \fooindex such that | |
4235 % \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo. | |
4236 % It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for | |
4237 % the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo. | |
4238 % The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long | |
4239 % for the sake of vms. | |
4240 % | |
4241 \def\newindex#1{% | |
4242 \iflinks | |
4243 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname | |
4244 \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file | |
4245 \fi | |
4246 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index | |
4247 \noexpand\doindex{#1}} | |
4248 } | |
4249 | |
4250 % @defindex foo == \newindex{foo} | |
4251 % | |
4252 \def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex} | |
4253 | |
4254 % Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code. | |
4255 % | |
4256 \def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex} | |
4257 % | |
4258 \def\newcodeindex#1{% | |
4259 \iflinks | |
4260 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname | |
4261 \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 | |
4262 \fi | |
4263 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% | |
4264 \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}% | |
4265 } | |
4266 | |
4267 | |
4268 % @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar. | |
4269 % Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index. | |
4270 % | |
4271 % @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo | |
4272 % inside @code. | |
4273 % | |
4274 \def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}} | |
4275 \def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}} | |
4276 | |
4277 % #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo), | |
4278 % #3 the target index (bar). | |
4279 \def\dosynindex#1#2#3{% | |
4280 % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up | |
4281 % closing the target index. | |
4282 \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname \relax | |
4283 % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the | |
4284 % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files. | |
4285 \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile\endcsname | |
4286 \expandafter\let\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname = 1 | |
4287 \fi | |
4288 % redefine \fooindfile: | |
4289 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname | |
4290 \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp | |
4291 % redefine \fooindex: | |
4292 \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}% | |
4293 } | |
4294 | |
4295 % Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros. | |
4296 % Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro, | |
4297 % and it is "foo", the name of the index. | |
4298 | |
4299 % \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work. | |
4300 % This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros. | |
4301 | |
4302 % There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic} | |
4303 % which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index. | |
4304 | |
4305 \def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer} | |
4306 \def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}} | |
4307 | |
4308 % like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument. | |
4309 \def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer} | |
4310 \def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}} | |
4311 | |
4312 % Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry. | |
4313 % Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't, | |
4314 % we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't. | |
4315 % | |
4316 \def\indexdummies{% | |
4317 \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files. | |
4318 \def\@{@}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files. | |
4319 \def\ {\realbackslash\space }% | |
4320 % | |
4321 % Need these unexpandable (because we define \tt as a dummy) | |
4322 % definitions when @{ or @} appear in index entry text. Also, more | |
4323 % complicated, when \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again. | |
4324 % We can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes | |
4325 % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters. Perhaps we | |
4326 % should define @lbrace and @rbrace commands a la @comma. | |
4327 \def\{{{\tt\char123}}% | |
4328 \def\}{{\tt\char125}}% | |
4329 % | |
4330 % I don't entirely understand this, but when an index entry is | |
4331 % generated from a macro call, the \endinput which \scanmacro inserts | |
4332 % causes processing to be prematurely terminated. This is, | |
4333 % apparently, because \indexsorttmp is fully expanded, and \endinput | |
4334 % is an expandable command. The redefinition below makes \endinput | |
4335 % disappear altogether for that purpose -- although logging shows that | |
4336 % processing continues to some further point. On the other hand, it | |
4337 % seems \endinput does not hurt in the printed index arg, since that | |
4338 % is still getting written without apparent harm. | |
4339 % | |
4340 % Sample source (mac-idx3.tex, reported by Graham Percival to | |
4341 % help-texinfo, 22may06): | |
4342 % @macro funindex {WORD} | |
4343 % @findex xyz | |
4344 % @end macro | |
4345 % ... | |
4346 % @funindex commtest | |
4347 % | |
4348 % The above is not enough to reproduce the bug, but it gives the flavor. | |
4349 % | |
4350 % Sample whatsit resulting: | |
4351 % .@write3{\entry{xyz}{@folio }{@code {xyz@endinput }}} | |
4352 % | |
4353 % So: | |
4354 \let\endinput = \empty | |
4355 % | |
4356 % Do the redefinitions. | |
4357 \commondummies | |
4358 } | |
4359 | |
4360 % For the aux and toc files, @ is the escape character. So we want to | |
4361 % redefine everything using @ as the escape character (instead of | |
4362 % \realbackslash, still used for index files). When everything uses @, | |
4363 % this will be simpler. | |
4364 % | |
4365 \def\atdummies{% | |
4366 \def\@{@@}% | |
4367 \def\ {@ }% | |
4368 \let\{ = \lbraceatcmd | |
4369 \let\} = \rbraceatcmd | |
4370 % | |
4371 % Do the redefinitions. | |
4372 \commondummies | |
4373 \otherbackslash | |
4374 } | |
4375 | |
4376 % Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies. | |
4377 % | |
4378 \def\commondummies{% | |
4379 % | |
4380 % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively | |
4381 % preventing its expansion. This is used only for control words, | |
4382 % not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for | |
4383 % control characters, but is needed to separate the control word | |
4384 % from whatever follows. | |
4385 % | |
4386 % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the | |
4387 % space. | |
4388 % | |
4389 % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and | |
4390 % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then | |
4391 % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever). | |
4392 % | |
4393 \def\definedummyword ##1{\def##1{\string##1\space}}% | |
4394 \def\definedummyletter##1{\def##1{\string##1}}% | |
4395 \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter | |
4396 % | |
4397 \commondummiesnofonts | |
4398 % | |
4399 \definedummyletter\_% | |
4400 \definedummyletter\-% | |
4401 % | |
4402 % Non-English letters. | |
4403 \definedummyword\AA | |
4404 \definedummyword\AE | |
4405 \definedummyword\DH | |
4406 \definedummyword\L | |
4407 \definedummyword\O | |
4408 \definedummyword\OE | |
4409 \definedummyword\TH | |
4410 \definedummyword\aa | |
4411 \definedummyword\ae | |
4412 \definedummyword\dh | |
4413 \definedummyword\exclamdown | |
4414 \definedummyword\l | |
4415 \definedummyword\o | |
4416 \definedummyword\oe | |
4417 \definedummyword\ordf | |
4418 \definedummyword\ordm | |
4419 \definedummyword\questiondown | |
4420 \definedummyword\ss | |
4421 \definedummyword\th | |
4422 % | |
4423 % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do. | |
4424 \definedummyword\bf | |
4425 \definedummyword\gtr | |
4426 \definedummyword\hat | |
4427 \definedummyword\less | |
4428 \definedummyword\sf | |
4429 \definedummyword\sl | |
4430 \definedummyword\tclose | |
4431 \definedummyword\tt | |
4432 % | |
4433 \definedummyword\LaTeX | |
4434 \definedummyword\TeX | |
4435 % | |
4436 % Assorted special characters. | |
4437 \definedummyword\arrow | |
4438 \definedummyword\bullet | |
4439 \definedummyword\comma | |
4440 \definedummyword\copyright | |
4441 \definedummyword\registeredsymbol | |
4442 \definedummyword\dots | |
4443 \definedummyword\enddots | |
4444 \definedummyword\entrybreak | |
4445 \definedummyword\equiv | |
4446 \definedummyword\error | |
4447 \definedummyword\euro | |
4448 \definedummyword\expansion | |
4449 \definedummyword\geq | |
4450 \definedummyword\guillemetleft | |
4451 \definedummyword\guillemetright | |
4452 \definedummyword\guilsinglleft | |
4453 \definedummyword\guilsinglright | |
4454 \definedummyword\leq | |
4455 \definedummyword\minus | |
4456 \definedummyword\ogonek | |
4457 \definedummyword\pounds | |
4458 \definedummyword\point | |
4459 \definedummyword\print | |
4460 \definedummyword\quotedblbase | |
4461 \definedummyword\quotedblleft | |
4462 \definedummyword\quotedblright | |
4463 \definedummyword\quoteleft | |
4464 \definedummyword\quoteright | |
4465 \definedummyword\quotesinglbase | |
4466 \definedummyword\result | |
4467 \definedummyword\textdegree | |
4468 % | |
4469 % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write. | |
4470 \macrolist | |
4471 % | |
4472 \normalturnoffactive | |
4473 % | |
4474 % Handle some cases of @value -- where it does not contain any | |
4475 % (non-fully-expandable) commands. | |
4476 \makevalueexpandable | |
4477 } | |
4478 | |
4479 % \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts. | |
4480 % | |
4481 \def\commondummiesnofonts{% | |
4482 % Control letters and accents. | |
4483 \definedummyletter\!% | |
4484 \definedummyaccent\"% | |
4485 \definedummyaccent\'% | |
4486 \definedummyletter\*% | |
4487 \definedummyaccent\,% | |
4488 \definedummyletter\.% | |
4489 \definedummyletter\/% | |
4490 \definedummyletter\:% | |
4491 \definedummyaccent\=% | |
4492 \definedummyletter\?% | |
4493 \definedummyaccent\^% | |
4494 \definedummyaccent\`% | |
4495 \definedummyaccent\~% | |
4496 \definedummyword\u | |
4497 \definedummyword\v | |
4498 \definedummyword\H | |
4499 \definedummyword\dotaccent | |
4500 \definedummyword\ogonek | |
4501 \definedummyword\ringaccent | |
4502 \definedummyword\tieaccent | |
4503 \definedummyword\ubaraccent | |
4504 \definedummyword\udotaccent | |
4505 \definedummyword\dotless | |
4506 % | |
4507 % Texinfo font commands. | |
4508 \definedummyword\b | |
4509 \definedummyword\i | |
4510 \definedummyword\r | |
4511 \definedummyword\sansserif | |
4512 \definedummyword\sc | |
4513 \definedummyword\slanted | |
4514 \definedummyword\t | |
4515 % | |
4516 % Commands that take arguments. | |
4517 \definedummyword\acronym | |
4518 \definedummyword\anchor | |
4519 \definedummyword\cite | |
4520 \definedummyword\code | |
4521 \definedummyword\command | |
4522 \definedummyword\dfn | |
4523 \definedummyword\dmn | |
4524 \definedummyword\email | |
4525 \definedummyword\emph | |
4526 \definedummyword\env | |
4527 \definedummyword\file | |
4528 \definedummyword\indicateurl | |
4529 \definedummyword\kbd | |
4530 \definedummyword\key | |
4531 \definedummyword\math | |
4532 \definedummyword\option | |
4533 \definedummyword\pxref | |
4534 \definedummyword\ref | |
4535 \definedummyword\samp | |
4536 \definedummyword\strong | |
4537 \definedummyword\tie | |
4538 \definedummyword\uref | |
4539 \definedummyword\url | |
4540 \definedummyword\var | |
4541 \definedummyword\verb | |
4542 \definedummyword\w | |
4543 \definedummyword\xref | |
4544 } | |
4545 | |
4546 % \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index | |
4547 % by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all | |
4548 % control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string | |
4549 % would be for a given command (usually its argument). | |
4550 % | |
4551 \def\indexnofonts{% | |
4552 % Accent commands should become @asis. | |
4553 \def\definedummyaccent##1{\let##1\asis}% | |
4554 % We can just ignore other control letters. | |
4555 \def\definedummyletter##1{\let##1\empty}% | |
4556 % All control words become @asis by default; overrides below. | |
4557 \let\definedummyword\definedummyaccent | |
4558 % | |
4559 \commondummiesnofonts | |
4560 % | |
4561 % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command | |
4562 % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc. | |
4563 % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands. | |
4564 %\let\tt=\asis | |
4565 % | |
4566 \def\ { }% | |
4567 \def\@{@}% | |
4568 \def\_{\normalunderscore}% | |
4569 \def\-{}% @- shouldn't affect sorting | |
4570 % | |
4571 % Unfortunately, texindex is not prepared to handle braces in the | |
4572 % content at all. So for index sorting, we map @{ and @} to strings | |
4573 % starting with |, since that ASCII character is between ASCII { and }. | |
4574 \def\{{|a}% | |
4575 \def\}{|b}% | |
4576 % | |
4577 % Non-English letters. | |
4578 \def\AA{AA}% | |
4579 \def\AE{AE}% | |
4580 \def\DH{DZZ}% | |
4581 \def\L{L}% | |
4582 \def\OE{OE}% | |
4583 \def\O{O}% | |
4584 \def\TH{ZZZ}% | |
4585 \def\aa{aa}% | |
4586 \def\ae{ae}% | |
4587 \def\dh{dzz}% | |
4588 \def\exclamdown{!}% | |
4589 \def\l{l}% | |
4590 \def\oe{oe}% | |
4591 \def\ordf{a}% | |
4592 \def\ordm{o}% | |
4593 \def\o{o}% | |
4594 \def\questiondown{?}% | |
4595 \def\ss{ss}% | |
4596 \def\th{zzz}% | |
4597 % | |
4598 \def\LaTeX{LaTeX}% | |
4599 \def\TeX{TeX}% | |
4600 % | |
4601 % Assorted special characters. | |
4602 % (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.) | |
4603 \def\arrow{->}% | |
4604 \def\bullet{bullet}% | |
4605 \def\comma{,}% | |
4606 \def\copyright{copyright}% | |
4607 \def\dots{...}% | |
4608 \def\enddots{...}% | |
4609 \def\equiv{==}% | |
4610 \def\error{error}% | |
4611 \def\euro{euro}% | |
4612 \def\expansion{==>}% | |
4613 \def\geq{>=}% | |
4614 \def\guillemetleft{<<}% | |
4615 \def\guillemetright{>>}% | |
4616 \def\guilsinglleft{<}% | |
4617 \def\guilsinglright{>}% | |
4618 \def\leq{<=}% | |
4619 \def\minus{-}% | |
4620 \def\point{.}% | |
4621 \def\pounds{pounds}% | |
4622 \def\print{-|}% | |
4623 \def\quotedblbase{"}% | |
4624 \def\quotedblleft{"}% | |
4625 \def\quotedblright{"}% | |
4626 \def\quoteleft{`}% | |
4627 \def\quoteright{'}% | |
4628 \def\quotesinglbase{,}% | |
4629 \def\registeredsymbol{R}% | |
4630 \def\result{=>}% | |
4631 \def\textdegree{o}% | |
4632 % | |
4633 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexlquoteignore\endcsname\relax | |
4634 \else \indexlquoteignore \fi | |
4635 % | |
4636 % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present). | |
4637 % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now. | |
4638 % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up | |
4639 % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry | |
4640 % that starts with \. | |
4641 % | |
4642 % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them | |
4643 % to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that | |
4644 % goes to end-of-line is not handled. | |
4645 % | |
4646 \macrolist | |
4647 } | |
4648 | |
4649 % Undocumented (for FSFS 2nd ed.): @set txiindexlquoteignore makes us | |
4650 % ignore left quotes in the sort term. | |
4651 {\catcode`\`=\active | |
4652 \gdef\indexlquoteignore{\let`=\empty}} | |
4653 | |
4654 \let\indexbackslash=0 %overridden during \printindex. | |
4655 \let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)? | |
4656 | |
4657 % Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case. | |
4658 % #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text. | |
4659 \def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}} | |
4660 | |
4661 % Workhorse for all \fooindexes. | |
4662 % #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry -- | |
4663 % empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception | |
4664 % is with most defuns, which call us directly). | |
4665 % | |
4666 \def\dosubind#1#2#3{% | |
4667 \iflinks | |
4668 {% | |
4669 % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg). | |
4670 \toks0 = {#2}% | |
4671 % If third arg is present, precede it with a space. | |
4672 \def\thirdarg{#3}% | |
4673 \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else | |
4674 \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}% | |
4675 \fi | |
4676 % | |
4677 \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}% | |
4678 % | |
4679 \safewhatsit\dosubindwrite | |
4680 }% | |
4681 \fi | |
4682 } | |
4683 | |
4684 % Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file: | |
4685 % | |
4686 \def\dosubindwrite{% | |
4687 % Put the index entry in the margin if desired. | |
4688 \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else | |
4689 \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \the\toks0}}% | |
4690 \fi | |
4691 % | |
4692 % Remember, we are within a group. | |
4693 \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage | |
4694 \def\backslashcurfont{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now | |
4695 % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash. | |
4696 % | |
4697 % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to | |
4698 % get the string to sort by. | |
4699 {\indexnofonts | |
4700 \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion | |
4701 \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}% | |
4702 }% | |
4703 % | |
4704 % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and | |
4705 % the original text, including any font commands. We write | |
4706 % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the | |
4707 % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s | |
4708 % sorted result. | |
4709 \edef\temp{% | |
4710 \write\writeto{% | |
4711 \string\entry{\indexsorttmp}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}% | |
4712 }% | |
4713 \temp | |
4714 } | |
4715 | |
4716 % Take care of unwanted page breaks/skips around a whatsit: | |
4717 % | |
4718 % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it | |
4719 % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting | |
4720 % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the | |
4721 % \write or \pdfdest will make \lastskip zero. The result is that | |
4722 % sequences like this: | |
4723 % @end defun | |
4724 % @tindex whatever | |
4725 % @defun ... | |
4726 % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the | |
4727 % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of | |
4728 % the previous defun. | |
4729 % | |
4730 % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We | |
4731 % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph. | |
4732 % | |
4733 % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too. | |
4734 % | |
4735 % But wait, there is a catch there: | |
4736 % We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not | |
4737 % sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts | |
4738 % of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual | |
4739 % representation of the skip. | |
4740 % | |
4741 % The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that | |
4742 % the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter). | |
4743 % | |
4744 \edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname} | |
4745 % | |
4746 \newskip\whatsitskip | |
4747 \newcount\whatsitpenalty | |
4748 % | |
4749 % ..., ready, GO: | |
4750 % | |
4751 \def\safewhatsit#1{\ifhmode | |
4752 #1% | |
4753 \else | |
4754 % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously. | |
4755 \whatsitskip = \lastskip | |
4756 \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}% | |
4757 \whatsitpenalty = \lastpenalty | |
4758 % | |
4759 % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a | |
4760 % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this | |
4761 % -\whatsitskip glue we're inserting is preceded by a | |
4762 % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential | |
4763 % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed. | |
4764 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro | |
4765 \else | |
4766 \vskip-\whatsitskip | |
4767 \fi | |
4768 % | |
4769 #1% | |
4770 % | |
4771 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro | |
4772 % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and | |
4773 % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want | |
4774 % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various | |
4775 % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any | |
4776 % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example: | |
4777 % @deffn deffn-whatever | |
4778 % @vindex index-whatever | |
4779 % Description. | |
4780 % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit | |
4781 % and the "Description." paragraph. | |
4782 \ifnum\whatsitpenalty>9999 \penalty\whatsitpenalty \fi | |
4783 \else | |
4784 % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip, | |
4785 % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item | |
4786 % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak. | |
4787 \nobreak\vskip\whatsitskip | |
4788 \fi | |
4789 \fi} | |
4790 | |
4791 % The index entry written in the file actually looks like | |
4792 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic} | |
4793 % or | |
4794 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic} | |
4795 % The texindex program reads in these files and writes files | |
4796 % containing these kinds of lines: | |
4797 % \initial {c} | |
4798 % before the first topic whose initial is c | |
4799 % \entry {topic}{pagelist} | |
4800 % for a topic that is used without subtopics | |
4801 % \primary {topic} | |
4802 % for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics | |
4803 % \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist} | |
4804 % for each subtopic. | |
4805 | |
4806 % Define the user-accessible indexing commands | |
4807 % @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex. | |
4808 | |
4809 \def\findex {\fnindex} | |
4810 \def\kindex {\kyindex} | |
4811 \def\cindex {\cpindex} | |
4812 \def\vindex {\vrindex} | |
4813 \def\tindex {\tpindex} | |
4814 \def\pindex {\pgindex} | |
4815 | |
4816 \def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub} | |
4817 {\obeylines % | |
4818 \gdef\cindexsub "#1" #2^^M{\endgroup % | |
4819 \dosubind{cp}{#2}{#1}}} | |
4820 | |
4821 % Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material. | |
4822 | |
4823 % @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed. | |
4824 % It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered). | |
4825 % | |
4826 \parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup | |
4827 \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}% | |
4828 % | |
4829 \smallfonts \rm | |
4830 \tolerance = 9500 | |
4831 \plainfrenchspacing | |
4832 \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression. | |
4833 % | |
4834 % See if the index file exists and is nonempty. | |
4835 % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains | |
4836 % \initial {@} | |
4837 % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces | |
4838 % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence). | |
4839 \catcode`\@ = 11 | |
4840 \openin 1 \jobname.#1s | |
4841 \ifeof 1 | |
4842 % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index, | |
4843 % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the | |
4844 % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure | |
4845 % there is some text. | |
4846 \putwordIndexNonexistent | |
4847 \else | |
4848 % | |
4849 % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof | |
4850 % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so | |
4851 % it can discover if there is anything in it. | |
4852 \read 1 to \temp | |
4853 \ifeof 1 | |
4854 \putwordIndexIsEmpty | |
4855 \else | |
4856 % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape | |
4857 % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change | |
4858 % to make right now. | |
4859 \def\indexbackslash{\backslashcurfont}% | |
4860 \catcode`\\ = 0 | |
4861 \escapechar = `\\ | |
4862 \begindoublecolumns | |
4863 \input \jobname.#1s | |
4864 \enddoublecolumns | |
4865 \fi | |
4866 \fi | |
4867 \closein 1 | |
4868 \endgroup} | |
4869 | |
4870 % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself. | |
4871 % Change them to control the appearance of the index. | |
4872 | |
4873 \def\initial#1{{% | |
4874 % Some minor font changes for the special characters. | |
4875 \let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt | |
4876 % | |
4877 % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own. | |
4878 \removelastskip | |
4879 % | |
4880 % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus. | |
4881 \nobreak | |
4882 \vskip 0pt plus 3\baselineskip | |
4883 \penalty 0 | |
4884 \vskip 0pt plus -3\baselineskip | |
4885 % | |
4886 % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of | |
4887 % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column | |
4888 % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch | |
4889 % we need before each entry, but it's better. | |
4890 % | |
4891 % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns. | |
4892 \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip | |
4893 \leftline{\secbf #1}% | |
4894 % Do our best not to break after the initial. | |
4895 \nobreak | |
4896 \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip | |
4897 }} | |
4898 | |
4899 % \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and | |
4900 % then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index | |
4901 % and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip. | |
4902 % | |
4903 % A straightforward implementation would start like this: | |
4904 % \def\entry#1#2{... | |
4905 % But this freezes the catcodes in the argument, and can cause problems to | |
4906 % @code, which sets - active. This problem was fixed by a kludge--- | |
4907 % ``-'' was active throughout whole index, but this isn't really right. | |
4908 % The right solution is to prevent \entry from swallowing the whole text. | |
4909 % --kasal, 21nov03 | |
4910 \def\entry{% | |
4911 \begingroup | |
4912 % | |
4913 % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't | |
4914 % affect previous text. | |
4915 \par | |
4916 % | |
4917 % Do not fill out the last line with white space. | |
4918 \parfillskip = 0in | |
4919 % | |
4920 % No extra space above this paragraph. | |
4921 \parskip = 0in | |
4922 % | |
4923 % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines. | |
4924 \finalhyphendemerits = 0 | |
4925 % | |
4926 % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number | |
4927 % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the | |
4928 % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large | |
4929 % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across | |
4930 % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders. | |
4931 % | |
4932 % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start | |
4933 % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that. | |
4934 \hangindent = 2em | |
4935 % | |
4936 % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line | |
4937 % with blank space. | |
4938 \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil | |
4939 % | |
4940 % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing | |
4941 % columns. | |
4942 \vskip 0pt plus1pt | |
4943 % | |
4944 % When reading the text of entry, convert explicit line breaks | |
4945 % from @* into spaces. The user might give these in long section | |
4946 % titles, for instance. | |
4947 \def\*{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}% | |
4948 \def\entrybreak{\hfil\break}% | |
4949 % | |
4950 % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter): | |
4951 \afterassignment\doentry | |
4952 \let\temp = | |
4953 } | |
4954 \def\entrybreak{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}% | |
4955 \def\doentry{% | |
4956 \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace. | |
4957 \noindent | |
4958 \aftergroup\finishentry | |
4959 % And now comes the text of the entry. | |
4960 } | |
4961 \def\finishentry#1{% | |
4962 % #1 is the page number. | |
4963 % | |
4964 % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if | |
4965 % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be | |
4966 % cursed by a Unix daemon. | |
4967 \setbox\boxA = \hbox{#1}% | |
4968 \ifdim\wd\boxA = 0pt | |
4969 \ % | |
4970 \else | |
4971 % | |
4972 % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out | |
4973 % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the | |
4974 % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.) | |
4975 \hfil\penalty50 | |
4976 \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number. | |
4977 % | |
4978 % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as | |
4979 % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull | |
4980 % \hbox ensues. | |
4981 \ifpdf | |
4982 \pdfgettoks#1.% | |
4983 \ \the\toksA | |
4984 \else | |
4985 \ #1% | |
4986 \fi | |
4987 \fi | |
4988 \par | |
4989 \endgroup | |
4990 } | |
4991 | |
4992 % Like plain.tex's \dotfill, except uses up at least 1 em. | |
4993 \def\indexdotfill{\cleaders | |
4994 \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu.\mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill} | |
4995 | |
4996 \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}} | |
4997 | |
4998 \newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm | |
4999 \def\secondary#1#2{{% | |
5000 \parfillskip=0in | |
5001 \parskip=0in | |
5002 \hangindent=1in | |
5003 \hangafter=1 | |
5004 \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill | |
5005 \ifpdf | |
5006 \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph. | |
5007 \else | |
5008 #2 | |
5009 \fi | |
5010 \par | |
5011 }} | |
5012 | |
5013 % Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes. | |
5014 % Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say, | |
5015 % the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself. | |
5016 \catcode`\@=11 | |
5017 | |
5018 \newbox\partialpage | |
5019 \newdimen\doublecolumnhsize | |
5020 | |
5021 \def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns | |
5022 % Grab any single-column material above us. | |
5023 \output = {% | |
5024 % | |
5025 % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a | |
5026 % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output | |
5027 % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is | |
5028 % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In | |
5029 % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal | |
5030 % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this | |
5031 % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case. | |
5032 \ifvoid\partialpage \else | |
5033 \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}% | |
5034 \fi | |
5035 % | |
5036 \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{% | |
5037 % Unvbox the main output page. | |
5038 \unvbox\PAGE | |
5039 \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip | |
5040 }% | |
5041 }% | |
5042 \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage | |
5043 % | |
5044 % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages. | |
5045 \output = {\doublecolumnout}% | |
5046 % | |
5047 % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this | |
5048 % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11 | |
5049 % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple | |
5050 % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the | |
5051 % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place. | |
5052 % | |
5053 % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between | |
5054 % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it | |
5055 % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant | |
5056 % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt) | |
5057 % as it did when we hard-coded it. | |
5058 % | |
5059 % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we | |
5060 % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially) | |
5061 % been clobbered. | |
5062 % | |
5063 \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize | |
5064 \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize | |
5065 \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2 | |
5066 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize | |
5067 % | |
5068 % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here, | |
5069 % since nobody clobbers \vsize.) | |
5070 \vsize = 2\vsize | |
5071 } | |
5072 | |
5073 % The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except | |
5074 % the last. | |
5075 % | |
5076 \def\doublecolumnout{% | |
5077 \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth | |
5078 % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal | |
5079 % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the | |
5080 % previous page. | |
5081 \dimen@ = \vsize | |
5082 \divide\dimen@ by 2 | |
5083 \advance\dimen@ by -\ht\partialpage | |
5084 % | |
5085 % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right. | |
5086 \setbox0=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ | |
5087 \onepageout\pagesofar | |
5088 \unvbox255 | |
5089 \penalty\outputpenalty | |
5090 } | |
5091 % | |
5092 % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material, | |
5093 % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2. | |
5094 \def\pagesofar{% | |
5095 \unvbox\partialpage | |
5096 % | |
5097 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize | |
5098 \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize | |
5099 \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}% | |
5100 } | |
5101 % | |
5102 % All done with double columns. | |
5103 \def\enddoublecolumns{% | |
5104 % The following penalty ensures that the page builder is exercised | |
5105 % _before_ we change the output routine. This is necessary in the | |
5106 % following situation: | |
5107 % | |
5108 % The last section of the index consists only of a single entry. | |
5109 % Before this section, \pagetotal is less than \pagegoal, so no | |
5110 % break occurs before the last section starts. However, the last | |
5111 % section, consisting of \initial and the single \entry, does not | |
5112 % fit on the page and has to be broken off. Without the following | |
5113 % penalty the page builder will not be exercised until \eject | |
5114 % below, and by that time we'll already have changed the output | |
5115 % routine to the \balancecolumns version, so the next-to-last | |
5116 % double-column page will be processed with \balancecolumns, which | |
5117 % is wrong: The two columns will go to the main vertical list, with | |
5118 % the broken-off section in the recent contributions. As soon as | |
5119 % the output routine finishes, TeX starts reconsidering the page | |
5120 % break. The two columns and the broken-off section both fit on the | |
5121 % page, because the two columns now take up only half of the page | |
5122 % goal. When TeX sees \eject from below which follows the final | |
5123 % section, it invokes the new output routine that we've set after | |
5124 % \balancecolumns below; \onepageout will try to fit the two columns | |
5125 % and the final section into the vbox of \pageheight (see | |
5126 % \pagebody), causing an overfull box. | |
5127 % | |
5128 % Note that glue won't work here, because glue does not exercise the | |
5129 % page builder, unlike penalties (see The TeXbook, pp. 280-281). | |
5130 \penalty0 | |
5131 % | |
5132 \output = {% | |
5133 % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the | |
5134 % current page, no automatic page break. | |
5135 \balancecolumns | |
5136 % | |
5137 % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page, | |
5138 % though, there will be another page break right after this \output | |
5139 % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not | |
5140 % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal | |
5141 % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be | |
5142 % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes | |
5143 % the output somewhat more palatable.) | |
5144 \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}% | |
5145 }% | |
5146 \eject | |
5147 \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns | |
5148 % | |
5149 % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted | |
5150 % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column | |
5151 % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the | |
5152 % \endgroup where \vsize got restored). | |
5153 \pagegoal = \vsize | |
5154 } | |
5155 % | |
5156 % Called at the end of the double column material. | |
5157 \def\balancecolumns{% | |
5158 \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120. | |
5159 \dimen@ = \ht0 | |
5160 \advance\dimen@ by \topskip | |
5161 \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip | |
5162 \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to | |
5163 %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}% | |
5164 \splittopskip = \topskip | |
5165 % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint. | |
5166 {% | |
5167 \vbadness = 10000 | |
5168 \loop | |
5169 \global\setbox3 = \copy0 | |
5170 \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@ | |
5171 \ifdim\ht3>\dimen@ | |
5172 \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt | |
5173 \repeat | |
5174 }% | |
5175 %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}% | |
5176 \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}% | |
5177 \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}% | |
5178 % | |
5179 \pagesofar | |
5180 } | |
5181 \catcode`\@ = \other | |
5182 | |
5183 | |
5184 \message{sectioning,} | |
5185 % Chapters, sections, etc. | |
5186 | |
5187 % Let's start with @part. | |
5188 \outer\parseargdef\part{\partzzz{#1}} | |
5189 \def\partzzz#1{% | |
5190 \chapoddpage | |
5191 \null | |
5192 \vskip.3\vsize % move it down on the page a bit | |
5193 \begingroup | |
5194 \noindent \titlefonts\rmisbold #1\par % the text | |
5195 \let\lastnode=\empty % no node to associate with | |
5196 \writetocentry{part}{#1}{}% but put it in the toc | |
5197 \headingsoff % no headline or footline on the part page | |
5198 \chapoddpage | |
5199 \endgroup | |
5200 } | |
5201 | |
5202 % \unnumberedno is an oxymoron. But we count the unnumbered | |
5203 % sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf | |
5204 % outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter | |
5205 % numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000 | |
5206 % chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.) | |
5207 \newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000 | |
5208 \newcount\chapno | |
5209 \newcount\secno \secno=0 | |
5210 \newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0 | |
5211 \newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0 | |
5212 | |
5213 % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ... | |
5214 \newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@ | |
5215 % | |
5216 % \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno} | |
5217 % We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple | |
5218 % construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual | |
5219 % letter in the expansion, not just typeset. | |
5220 % | |
5221 \def\appendixletter{% | |
5222 \ifnum\appendixno=`A A% | |
5223 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B% | |
5224 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C% | |
5225 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D% | |
5226 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E% | |
5227 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F% | |
5228 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G% | |
5229 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H% | |
5230 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I% | |
5231 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J% | |
5232 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K% | |
5233 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L% | |
5234 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M% | |
5235 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N% | |
5236 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O% | |
5237 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P% | |
5238 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q% | |
5239 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R% | |
5240 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S% | |
5241 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T% | |
5242 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U% | |
5243 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V% | |
5244 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W% | |
5245 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X% | |
5246 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y% | |
5247 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z% | |
5248 % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is | |
5249 % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not | |
5250 % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out | |
5251 % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it. | |
5252 \else\char\the\appendixno | |
5253 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi | |
5254 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi} | |
5255 | |
5256 % Each @chapter defines these (using marks) as the number+name, number | |
5257 % and name of the chapter. Page headings and footings can use | |
5258 % these. @section does likewise. | |
5259 \def\thischapter{} | |
5260 \def\thischapternum{} | |
5261 \def\thischaptername{} | |
5262 \def\thissection{} | |
5263 \def\thissectionnum{} | |
5264 \def\thissectionname{} | |
5265 | |
5266 \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level | |
5267 \newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count | |
5268 | |
5269 % @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc. | |
5270 \def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1} | |
5271 \let\up=\raisesections % original BFox name | |
5272 | |
5273 % @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc. | |
5274 \def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1} | |
5275 \let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name | |
5276 | |
5277 % we only have subsub. | |
5278 \chardef\maxseclevel = 3 | |
5279 % | |
5280 % A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too. | |
5281 % To achieve this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in: | |
5282 \chardef\unnlevel = \maxseclevel | |
5283 % | |
5284 % Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not: | |
5285 % \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored. | |
5286 \def\chapheadtype{N} | |
5287 | |
5288 % Choose a heading macro | |
5289 % #1 is heading type | |
5290 % #2 is heading level | |
5291 % #3 is text for heading | |
5292 \def\genhead#1#2#3{% | |
5293 % Compute the abs. sec. level: | |
5294 \absseclevel=#2 | |
5295 \advance\absseclevel by \secbase | |
5296 % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range: | |
5297 \ifnum \absseclevel < 0 | |
5298 \absseclevel = 0 | |
5299 \else | |
5300 \ifnum \absseclevel > 3 | |
5301 \absseclevel = 3 | |
5302 \fi | |
5303 \fi | |
5304 % The heading type: | |
5305 \def\headtype{#1}% | |
5306 \if \headtype U% | |
5307 \ifnum \absseclevel < \unnlevel | |
5308 \chardef\unnlevel = \absseclevel | |
5309 \fi | |
5310 \else | |
5311 % Check for appendix sections: | |
5312 \ifnum \absseclevel = 0 | |
5313 \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}% | |
5314 \else | |
5315 \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N% | |
5316 \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter}% | |
5317 \fi\fi | |
5318 \fi | |
5319 % Check for numbered within unnumbered: | |
5320 \ifnum \absseclevel > \unnlevel | |
5321 \def\headtype{U}% | |
5322 \else | |
5323 \chardef\unnlevel = 3 | |
5324 \fi | |
5325 \fi | |
5326 % Now print the heading: | |
5327 \if \headtype U% | |
5328 \ifcase\absseclevel | |
5329 \unnumberedzzz{#3}% | |
5330 \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}% | |
5331 \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}% | |
5332 \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}% | |
5333 \fi | |
5334 \else | |
5335 \if \headtype A% | |
5336 \ifcase\absseclevel | |
5337 \appendixzzz{#3}% | |
5338 \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}% | |
5339 \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}% | |
5340 \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}% | |
5341 \fi | |
5342 \else | |
5343 \ifcase\absseclevel | |
5344 \chapterzzz{#3}% | |
5345 \or \seczzz{#3}% | |
5346 \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}% | |
5347 \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}% | |
5348 \fi | |
5349 \fi | |
5350 \fi | |
5351 \suppressfirstparagraphindent | |
5352 } | |
5353 | |
5354 % an interface: | |
5355 \def\numhead{\genhead N} | |
5356 \def\apphead{\genhead A} | |
5357 \def\unnmhead{\genhead U} | |
5358 | |
5359 % @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset | |
5360 % all lower-level sectioning counters to zero. | |
5361 % | |
5362 % Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers | |
5363 % (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty. | |
5364 \let\chaplevelprefix = \empty | |
5365 % | |
5366 \outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz | |
5367 \def\chapterzzz#1{% | |
5368 % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such | |
5369 % as an @include file. | |
5370 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 | |
5371 \global\advance\chapno by 1 | |
5372 % | |
5373 % Used for \float. | |
5374 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}% | |
5375 \resetallfloatnos | |
5376 % | |
5377 % \putwordChapter can contain complex things in translations. | |
5378 \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordChapter}% | |
5379 \message{\the\toks0 \space \the\chapno}% | |
5380 % | |
5381 % Write the actual heading. | |
5382 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}% | |
5383 % | |
5384 % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter. | |
5385 \global\let\section = \numberedsec | |
5386 \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec | |
5387 \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec | |
5388 } | |
5389 | |
5390 \outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally calls appendixzzz | |
5391 % | |
5392 \def\appendixzzz#1{% | |
5393 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 | |
5394 \global\advance\appendixno by 1 | |
5395 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}% | |
5396 \resetallfloatnos | |
5397 % | |
5398 % \putwordAppendix can contain complex things in translations. | |
5399 \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordAppendix}% | |
5400 \message{\the\toks0 \space \appendixletter}% | |
5401 % | |
5402 \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}% | |
5403 % | |
5404 \global\let\section = \appendixsec | |
5405 \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec | |
5406 \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec | |
5407 } | |
5408 | |
5409 % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz: | |
5410 \outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}} | |
5411 \def\unnumberedzzz#1{% | |
5412 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 | |
5413 \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1 | |
5414 % | |
5415 % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures. | |
5416 \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty | |
5417 \resetallfloatnos | |
5418 % | |
5419 % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the | |
5420 % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX | |
5421 % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX | |
5422 % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant | |
5423 % to be executed, not expanded). | |
5424 % | |
5425 % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear | |
5426 % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use | |
5427 % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once, | |
5428 % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for | |
5429 % the toc entries.) | |
5430 \toks0 = {#1}% | |
5431 \message{(\the\toks0)}% | |
5432 % | |
5433 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}% | |
5434 % | |
5435 \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec | |
5436 \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec | |
5437 \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec | |
5438 } | |
5439 | |
5440 % @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered. | |
5441 \outer\parseargdef\centerchap{% | |
5442 % Well, we could do the following in a group, but that would break | |
5443 % an assumption that \chapmacro is called at the outermost level. | |
5444 % Thus we are safer this way: --kasal, 24feb04 | |
5445 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters | |
5446 \unnmhead0{#1}% | |
5447 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax | |
5448 } | |
5449 | |
5450 % @top is like @unnumbered. | |
5451 \let\top\unnumbered | |
5452 | |
5453 % Sections. | |
5454 % | |
5455 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz | |
5456 \def\seczzz#1{% | |
5457 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1 | |
5458 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}% | |
5459 } | |
5460 | |
5461 % normally calls appendixsectionzzz: | |
5462 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}} | |
5463 \def\appendixsectionzzz#1{% | |
5464 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1 | |
5465 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}% | |
5466 } | |
5467 \let\appendixsec\appendixsection | |
5468 | |
5469 % normally calls unnumberedseczzz: | |
5470 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}} | |
5471 \def\unnumberedseczzz#1{% | |
5472 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1 | |
5473 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}% | |
5474 } | |
5475 | |
5476 % Subsections. | |
5477 % | |
5478 % normally calls numberedsubseczzz: | |
5479 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}} | |
5480 \def\numberedsubseczzz#1{% | |
5481 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1 | |
5482 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}% | |
5483 } | |
5484 | |
5485 % normally calls appendixsubseczzz: | |
5486 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}} | |
5487 \def\appendixsubseczzz#1{% | |
5488 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1 | |
5489 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}% | |
5490 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}% | |
5491 } | |
5492 | |
5493 % normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz: | |
5494 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}} | |
5495 \def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{% | |
5496 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1 | |
5497 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}% | |
5498 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}% | |
5499 } | |
5500 | |
5501 % Subsubsections. | |
5502 % | |
5503 % normally numberedsubsubseczzz: | |
5504 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}} | |
5505 \def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{% | |
5506 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1 | |
5507 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}% | |
5508 {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}% | |
5509 } | |
5510 | |
5511 % normally appendixsubsubseczzz: | |
5512 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}} | |
5513 \def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{% | |
5514 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1 | |
5515 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}% | |
5516 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}% | |
5517 } | |
5518 | |
5519 % normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz: | |
5520 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}} | |
5521 \def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{% | |
5522 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1 | |
5523 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}% | |
5524 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}% | |
5525 } | |
5526 | |
5527 % These macros control what the section commands do, according | |
5528 % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered). | |
5529 % Define them by default for a numbered chapter. | |
5530 \let\section = \numberedsec | |
5531 \let\subsection = \numberedsubsec | |
5532 \let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec | |
5533 | |
5534 % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading | |
5535 | |
5536 % NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and such: | |
5537 % 1) We use \vbox rather than the earlier \line to permit | |
5538 % overlong headings to fold. | |
5539 % 2) \hyphenpenalty is set to 10000 because hyphenation in a | |
5540 % heading is obnoxious; this forbids it. | |
5541 % 3) Likewise, headings look best if no \parindent is used, and | |
5542 % if justification is not attempted. Hence \raggedright. | |
5543 | |
5544 \def\majorheading{% | |
5545 {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }% | |
5546 \parsearg\chapheadingzzz | |
5547 } | |
5548 | |
5549 \def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz} | |
5550 \def\chapheadingzzz#1{% | |
5551 {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 | |
5552 \parindent=0pt\ptexraggedright | |
5553 \rmisbold #1\hfill}}% | |
5554 \bigskip \par\penalty 200\relax | |
5555 \suppressfirstparagraphindent | |
5556 } | |
5557 | |
5558 % @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading. | |
5559 \parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{} | |
5560 \suppressfirstparagraphindent} | |
5561 \parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{} | |
5562 \suppressfirstparagraphindent} | |
5563 \parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{} | |
5564 \suppressfirstparagraphindent} | |
5565 | |
5566 % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only | |
5567 % (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it), | |
5568 % given all the information in convenient, parsed form. | |
5569 | |
5570 % Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative) | |
5571 \def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi} | |
5572 | |
5573 % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed) | |
5574 \newskip\chapheadingskip | |
5575 | |
5576 % Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it. | |
5577 \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}} | |
5578 \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject} | |
5579 % Because \domark is called before \chapoddpage, the filler page will | |
5580 % get the headings for the next chapter, which is wrong. But we don't | |
5581 % care -- we just disable all headings on the filler page. | |
5582 \def\chapoddpage{% | |
5583 \chappager | |
5584 \ifodd\pageno \else | |
5585 \begingroup | |
5586 \headingsoff | |
5587 \null | |
5588 \chappager | |
5589 \endgroup | |
5590 \fi | |
5591 } | |
5592 | |
5593 \def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname} | |
5594 | |
5595 \def\CHAPPAGoff{% | |
5596 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager | |
5597 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak | |
5598 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager} | |
5599 | |
5600 \def\CHAPPAGon{% | |
5601 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager | |
5602 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager | |
5603 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager | |
5604 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}} | |
5605 | |
5606 \def\CHAPPAGodd{% | |
5607 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage | |
5608 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage | |
5609 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage | |
5610 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}} | |
5611 | |
5612 \CHAPPAGon | |
5613 | |
5614 % Chapter opening. | |
5615 % | |
5616 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing, | |
5617 % Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number. | |
5618 % | |
5619 % To test against our argument. | |
5620 \def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing} | |
5621 \def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc} | |
5622 \def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix} | |
5623 % | |
5624 \def\chapmacro#1#2#3{% | |
5625 % Insert the first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark). | |
5626 \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs | |
5627 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs | |
5628 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{}\gdef\thissectionnum{}% | |
5629 \gdef\thissection{}}% | |
5630 % | |
5631 \def\temptype{#2}% | |
5632 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword | |
5633 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}% | |
5634 \gdef\thischapter{\thischaptername}}% | |
5635 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword | |
5636 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}% | |
5637 \gdef\thischapter{}}% | |
5638 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword | |
5639 \toks0={#1}% | |
5640 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{% | |
5641 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}% | |
5642 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\appendixletter}% | |
5643 % \noexpand\putwordAppendix avoids expanding indigestible | |
5644 % commands in some of the translations. | |
5645 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordAppendix{} | |
5646 \noexpand\thischapternum: | |
5647 \noexpand\thischaptername}% | |
5648 }% | |
5649 \else | |
5650 \toks0={#1}% | |
5651 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{% | |
5652 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}% | |
5653 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\the\chapno}% | |
5654 % \noexpand\putwordChapter avoids expanding indigestible | |
5655 % commands in some of the translations. | |
5656 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordChapter{} | |
5657 \noexpand\thischapternum: | |
5658 \noexpand\thischaptername}% | |
5659 }% | |
5660 \fi\fi\fi | |
5661 % | |
5662 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of | |
5663 % the preceding space. | |
5664 \safewhatsit\domark | |
5665 % | |
5666 % Insert the chapter heading break. | |
5667 \pchapsepmacro | |
5668 % | |
5669 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points | |
5670 % between here and the heading. | |
5671 \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs | |
5672 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs | |
5673 \domark | |
5674 % | |
5675 {% | |
5676 \chapfonts \rmisbold | |
5677 % | |
5678 % Have to define \lastsection before calling \donoderef, because the | |
5679 % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called | |
5680 % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon. | |
5681 \gdef\lastsection{#1}% | |
5682 % | |
5683 % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix | |
5684 % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''. | |
5685 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword | |
5686 \setbox0 = \hbox{}% | |
5687 \def\toctype{unnchap}% | |
5688 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword | |
5689 \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry | |
5690 \def\toctype{omit}% | |
5691 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword | |
5692 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}% | |
5693 \def\toctype{app}% | |
5694 \else | |
5695 \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}% | |
5696 \def\toctype{numchap}% | |
5697 \fi\fi\fi | |
5698 % | |
5699 % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the | |
5700 % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc | |
5701 % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty. | |
5702 \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}% | |
5703 % | |
5704 % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make | |
5705 % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has | |
5706 % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the | |
5707 % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not | |
5708 % being visible, for instance under high magnification. | |
5709 \donoderef{#2}% | |
5710 % | |
5711 % Typeset the actual heading. | |
5712 \nobreak % Avoid page breaks at the interline glue. | |
5713 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \ptexraggedright | |
5714 \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe | |
5715 \unhbox0 #1\par}% | |
5716 }% | |
5717 \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title | |
5718 \nobreak | |
5719 } | |
5720 | |
5721 % @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered. | |
5722 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax | |
5723 \def\centerparameters{% | |
5724 \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip | |
5725 \leftskip = \rightskip | |
5726 \parfillskip = 0pt | |
5727 } | |
5728 | |
5729 | |
5730 % I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not | |
5731 % updating it with the new noderef stuff. We'll see. --karl, 11aug03. | |
5732 % | |
5733 \def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname} | |
5734 % | |
5735 \def\unnchfopen #1{% | |
5736 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 | |
5737 \parindent=0pt\ptexraggedright | |
5738 \rmisbold #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak | |
5739 } | |
5740 \def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts | |
5741 \vbox to 3in{\vfil \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}% | |
5742 \par\penalty 5000 % | |
5743 } | |
5744 \def\centerchfopen #1{% | |
5745 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 | |
5746 \parindent=0pt | |
5747 \hfill {\rmisbold #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak | |
5748 } | |
5749 \def\CHAPFopen{% | |
5750 \global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen | |
5751 \global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen} | |
5752 | |
5753 | |
5754 % Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and | |
5755 % call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing. | |
5756 % | |
5757 \newskip\secheadingskip | |
5758 \def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}} | |
5759 | |
5760 % Subsection titles. | |
5761 \newskip\subsecheadingskip | |
5762 \def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}} | |
5763 | |
5764 % Subsubsection titles. | |
5765 \def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip} | |
5766 \def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak} | |
5767 | |
5768 | |
5769 % Print any size, any type, section title. | |
5770 % | |
5771 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #3 is | |
5772 % the section type for xrefs (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix), #4 is the | |
5773 % section number. | |
5774 % | |
5775 \def\seckeyword{sec} | |
5776 % | |
5777 \def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{% | |
5778 {% | |
5779 \checkenv{}% should not be in an environment. | |
5780 % | |
5781 % Switch to the right set of fonts. | |
5782 \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rmisbold | |
5783 % | |
5784 \def\sectionlevel{#2}% | |
5785 \def\temptype{#3}% | |
5786 % | |
5787 % Insert first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark). | |
5788 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs | |
5789 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword | |
5790 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword | |
5791 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{#1}\gdef\thissectionnum{}% | |
5792 \gdef\thissection{\thissectionname}}% | |
5793 \fi | |
5794 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword | |
5795 % Don't redefine \thissection. | |
5796 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword | |
5797 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword | |
5798 \toks0={#1}% | |
5799 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{% | |
5800 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}% | |
5801 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}% | |
5802 % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible | |
5803 % commands in some of the translations. | |
5804 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{} | |
5805 \noexpand\thissectionnum: | |
5806 \noexpand\thissectionname}% | |
5807 }% | |
5808 \fi | |
5809 \else | |
5810 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword | |
5811 \toks0={#1}% | |
5812 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{% | |
5813 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}% | |
5814 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}% | |
5815 % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible | |
5816 % commands in some of the translations. | |
5817 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{} | |
5818 \noexpand\thissectionnum: | |
5819 \noexpand\thissectionname}% | |
5820 }% | |
5821 \fi | |
5822 \fi\fi\fi | |
5823 % | |
5824 % Go into vertical mode. Usually we'll already be there, but we | |
5825 % don't want the following whatsit to end up in a preceding paragraph | |
5826 % if the document didn't happen to have a blank line. | |
5827 \par | |
5828 % | |
5829 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of | |
5830 % the preceding space. | |
5831 \safewhatsit\domark | |
5832 % | |
5833 % Insert space above the heading. | |
5834 \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname | |
5835 % | |
5836 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points | |
5837 % between here and the heading. | |
5838 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs | |
5839 \domark | |
5840 % | |
5841 % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number. | |
5842 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword | |
5843 \setbox0 = \hbox{}% | |
5844 \def\toctype{unn}% | |
5845 \gdef\lastsection{#1}% | |
5846 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword | |
5847 % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc, | |
5848 % and don't redefine \lastsection. | |
5849 \setbox0 = \hbox{}% | |
5850 \def\toctype{omit}% | |
5851 \let\sectionlevel=\empty | |
5852 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword | |
5853 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}% | |
5854 \def\toctype{app}% | |
5855 \gdef\lastsection{#1}% | |
5856 \else | |
5857 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}% | |
5858 \def\toctype{num}% | |
5859 \gdef\lastsection{#1}% | |
5860 \fi\fi\fi | |
5861 % | |
5862 % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chapmacro. | |
5863 \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}% | |
5864 % | |
5865 % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex). | |
5866 % Again, see comments in \chapmacro. | |
5867 \donoderef{#3}% | |
5868 % | |
5869 % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed. | |
5870 % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be | |
5871 % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the | |
5872 % \writetocentry if there was no node). We don't want to allow that | |
5873 % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the | |
5874 % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong. Debian bug 276000. | |
5875 \nobreak | |
5876 % | |
5877 % Output the actual section heading. | |
5878 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \ptexraggedright | |
5879 \hangindent=\wd0 % zero if no section number | |
5880 \unhbox0 #1}% | |
5881 }% | |
5882 % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it. | |
5883 % Don't allow stretch, though. | |
5884 \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname | |
5885 % | |
5886 % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it | |
5887 % was followed by glue. | |
5888 \nobreak | |
5889 % | |
5890 % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that | |
5891 % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a | |
5892 % discardable item.) However, when a paragraph is not started next | |
5893 % (\startdefun, \cartouche, \center, etc.), this needs to be wiped out | |
5894 % or the negative glue will cause weirdly wrong output, typically | |
5895 % obscuring the section heading with something else. | |
5896 \vskip-\parskip | |
5897 % | |
5898 % This is so the last item on the main vertical list is a known | |
5899 % \penalty > 10000, so \startdefun, etc., can recognize the situation | |
5900 % and do the needful. | |
5901 \penalty 10001 | |
5902 } | |
5903 | |
5904 | |
5905 \message{toc,} | |
5906 % Table of contents. | |
5907 \newwrite\tocfile | |
5908 | |
5909 % Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary. | |
5910 % Called from @chapter, etc. | |
5911 % | |
5912 % Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno} | |
5913 % We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional | |
5914 % arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually | |
5915 % read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the | |
5916 % destination to jump to. | |
5917 % | |
5918 % We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or | |
5919 % any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document. | |
5920 % But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the | |
5921 % table of contents chapter openings themselves. | |
5922 % | |
5923 \newif\iftocfileopened | |
5924 \def\omitkeyword{omit}% | |
5925 % | |
5926 \def\writetocentry#1#2#3{% | |
5927 \edef\writetoctype{#1}% | |
5928 \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else | |
5929 \iftocfileopened\else | |
5930 \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc | |
5931 \global\tocfileopenedtrue | |
5932 \fi | |
5933 % | |
5934 \iflinks | |
5935 {\atdummies | |
5936 \edef\temp{% | |
5937 \write\tocfile{@#1entry{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}% | |
5938 \temp | |
5939 }% | |
5940 \fi | |
5941 \fi | |
5942 % | |
5943 % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're | |
5944 % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't | |
5945 % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered | |
5946 % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first | |
5947 % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named | |
5948 % `1', and two named `2'. | |
5949 \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi | |
5950 } | |
5951 | |
5952 | |
5953 % These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman | |
5954 % fonts, so we must take special care. This is more or less redundant | |
5955 % with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file. | |
5956 % | |
5957 \def\activecatcodes{% | |
5958 \catcode`\"=\active | |
5959 \catcode`\$=\active | |
5960 \catcode`\<=\active | |
5961 \catcode`\>=\active | |
5962 \catcode`\\=\active | |
5963 \catcode`\^=\active | |
5964 \catcode`\_=\active | |
5965 \catcode`\|=\active | |
5966 \catcode`\~=\active | |
5967 } | |
5968 | |
5969 | |
5970 % Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input. | |
5971 \def\readtocfile{% | |
5972 \setupdatafile | |
5973 \activecatcodes | |
5974 \input \tocreadfilename | |
5975 } | |
5976 | |
5977 \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in | |
5978 \newcount\savepageno | |
5979 \newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1 | |
5980 | |
5981 % Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile. | |
5982 % | |
5983 \def\startcontents#1{% | |
5984 % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should | |
5985 % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain | |
5986 % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro. | |
5987 % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se> | |
5988 \contentsalignmacro | |
5989 \immediate\closeout\tocfile | |
5990 % | |
5991 % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline. | |
5992 % It is abundantly clear what they are. | |
5993 \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}% | |
5994 % | |
5995 \savepageno = \pageno | |
5996 \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly. | |
5997 \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom. | |
5998 \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length. | |
5999 % | |
6000 % Roman numerals for page numbers. | |
6001 \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi | |
6002 } | |
6003 | |
6004 % redefined for the two-volume lispref. We always output on | |
6005 % \jobname.toc even if this is redefined. | |
6006 % | |
6007 \def\tocreadfilename{\jobname.toc} | |
6008 | |
6009 % Normal (long) toc. | |
6010 % | |
6011 \def\contents{% | |
6012 \startcontents{\putwordTOC}% | |
6013 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space | |
6014 \ifeof 1 \else | |
6015 \readtocfile | |
6016 \fi | |
6017 \vfill \eject | |
6018 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect | |
6019 \ifeof 1 \else | |
6020 \pdfmakeoutlines | |
6021 \fi | |
6022 \closein 1 | |
6023 \endgroup | |
6024 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno | |
6025 \global\pageno = \savepageno | |
6026 } | |
6027 | |
6028 % And just the chapters. | |
6029 \def\summarycontents{% | |
6030 \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}% | |
6031 % | |
6032 \let\partentry = \shortpartentry | |
6033 \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry | |
6034 \let\appentry = \shortchapentry | |
6035 \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry | |
6036 % We want a true roman here for the page numbers. | |
6037 \secfonts | |
6038 \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf | |
6039 \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt | |
6040 \rm | |
6041 \hyphenpenalty = 10000 | |
6042 \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little. | |
6043 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{} | |
6044 \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry | |
6045 \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry | |
6046 \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry | |
6047 \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry | |
6048 \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry | |
6049 \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry | |
6050 \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry | |
6051 \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry | |
6052 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space | |
6053 \ifeof 1 \else | |
6054 \readtocfile | |
6055 \fi | |
6056 \closein 1 | |
6057 \vfill \eject | |
6058 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect | |
6059 \endgroup | |
6060 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno | |
6061 \global\pageno = \savepageno | |
6062 } | |
6063 \let\shortcontents = \summarycontents | |
6064 | |
6065 % Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents. | |
6066 % The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter. | |
6067 % | |
6068 \def\shortchaplabel#1{% | |
6069 % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the | |
6070 % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts. | |
6071 % But use \hss just in case. | |
6072 % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after | |
6073 % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.) | |
6074 % | |
6075 % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange | |
6076 % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and | |
6077 % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10 | |
6078 % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters | |
6079 % there are before deciding ... | |
6080 \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}% | |
6081 } | |
6082 | |
6083 % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents. | |
6084 % The first argument is the chapter or section name. | |
6085 % The last argument is the page number. | |
6086 % The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ... | |
6087 | |
6088 % Parts, in the main contents. Replace the part number, which doesn't | |
6089 % exist, with an empty box. Let's hope all the numbers have the same width. | |
6090 % Also ignore the page number, which is conventionally not printed. | |
6091 \def\numeralbox{\setbox0=\hbox{8}\hbox to \wd0{\hfil}} | |
6092 \def\partentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\numeralbox\labelspace#1}{}} | |
6093 % | |
6094 % Parts, in the short toc. | |
6095 \def\shortpartentry#1#2#3#4{% | |
6096 \penalty-300 | |
6097 \vskip.5\baselineskip plus.15\baselineskip minus.1\baselineskip | |
6098 \shortchapentry{{\bf #1}}{\numeralbox}{}{}% | |
6099 } | |
6100 | |
6101 % Chapters, in the main contents. | |
6102 \def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} | |
6103 % | |
6104 % Chapters, in the short toc. | |
6105 % See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings. | |
6106 \def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{% | |
6107 \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}% | |
6108 } | |
6109 | |
6110 % Appendices, in the main contents. | |
6111 % Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box. | |
6112 % | |
6113 \def\appendixbox#1{% | |
6114 % We use M since it's probably the widest letter. | |
6115 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}% | |
6116 \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}} | |
6117 % | |
6118 \def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\labelspace#1}{#4}} | |
6119 | |
6120 % Unnumbered chapters. | |
6121 \def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}} | |
6122 \def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}} | |
6123 | |
6124 % Sections. | |
6125 \def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} | |
6126 \let\appsecentry=\numsecentry | |
6127 \def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}} | |
6128 | |
6129 % Subsections. | |
6130 \def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} | |
6131 \let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry | |
6132 \def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}} | |
6133 | |
6134 % And subsubsections. | |
6135 \def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} | |
6136 \let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry | |
6137 \def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}} | |
6138 | |
6139 % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels. | |
6140 % Same as \defaultparindent. | |
6141 \newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt | |
6142 | |
6143 % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the | |
6144 % page number. | |
6145 % | |
6146 % If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters | |
6147 % if at all possible; hence the \penalty. | |
6148 \def\dochapentry#1#2{% | |
6149 \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip | |
6150 \begingroup | |
6151 \chapentryfonts | |
6152 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% | |
6153 \endgroup | |
6154 \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip | |
6155 } | |
6156 | |
6157 \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup | |
6158 \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent | |
6159 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% | |
6160 \endgroup} | |
6161 | |
6162 \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup | |
6163 \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent | |
6164 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% | |
6165 \endgroup} | |
6166 | |
6167 \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup | |
6168 \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent | |
6169 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% | |
6170 \endgroup} | |
6171 | |
6172 % We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries. | |
6173 \let\tocentry = \entry | |
6174 | |
6175 % Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title. | |
6176 \def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax} | |
6177 | |
6178 \def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}} | |
6179 \def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}} | |
6180 | |
6181 \def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm} | |
6182 \def\secentryfonts{\textfonts} | |
6183 \def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts} | |
6184 \def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts} | |
6185 | |
6186 | |
6187 \message{environments,} | |
6188 % @foo ... @end foo. | |
6189 | |
6190 % @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw TeX temporarily. | |
6191 % One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works. | |
6192 % But \@ or @@ will get a plain @ character. | |
6193 | |
6194 \envdef\tex{% | |
6195 \setupmarkupstyle{tex}% | |
6196 \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2 | |
6197 \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6 | |
6198 \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie | |
6199 \catcode `\%=14 | |
6200 \catcode `\+=\other | |
6201 \catcode `\"=\other | |
6202 \catcode `\|=\other | |
6203 \catcode `\<=\other | |
6204 \catcode `\>=\other | |
6205 \catcode`\`=\other | |
6206 \catcode`\'=\other | |
6207 \escapechar=`\\ | |
6208 % | |
6209 % ' is active in math mode (mathcode"8000). So reset it, and all our | |
6210 % other math active characters (just in case), to plain's definitions. | |
6211 \mathactive | |
6212 % | |
6213 \let\b=\ptexb | |
6214 \let\bullet=\ptexbullet | |
6215 \let\c=\ptexc | |
6216 \let\,=\ptexcomma | |
6217 \let\.=\ptexdot | |
6218 \let\dots=\ptexdots | |
6219 \let\equiv=\ptexequiv | |
6220 \let\!=\ptexexclam | |
6221 \let\i=\ptexi | |
6222 \let\indent=\ptexindent | |
6223 \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent | |
6224 \let\{=\ptexlbrace | |
6225 \let\+=\tabalign | |
6226 \let\}=\ptexrbrace | |
6227 \let\/=\ptexslash | |
6228 \let\*=\ptexstar | |
6229 \let\t=\ptext | |
6230 \expandafter \let\csname top\endcsname=\ptextop % outer | |
6231 \let\frenchspacing=\plainfrenchspacing | |
6232 % | |
6233 \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}% | |
6234 \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}% | |
6235 \def\@{@}% | |
6236 } | |
6237 % There is no need to define \Etex. | |
6238 | |
6239 % Define @lisp ... @end lisp. | |
6240 % @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things, | |
6241 % including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous). | |
6242 | |
6243 % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp. | |
6244 \newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in | |
6245 | |
6246 % This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other | |
6247 % such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't | |
6248 % have any width. | |
6249 \def\lisppar{\null\endgraf} | |
6250 | |
6251 % This space is always present above and below environments. | |
6252 \newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt | |
6253 | |
6254 % Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here | |
6255 % to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip | |
6256 % is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the | |
6257 % start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip. | |
6258 % | |
6259 \def\aboveenvbreak{{% | |
6260 % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and | |
6261 % \sectionheading, q.v. | |
6262 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else | |
6263 \advance\envskipamount by \parskip | |
6264 \endgraf | |
6265 \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount | |
6266 \removelastskip | |
6267 % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak | |
6268 % or better ... | |
6269 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi | |
6270 \vskip\envskipamount | |
6271 \fi | |
6272 \fi | |
6273 }} | |
6274 | |
6275 \let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak | |
6276 | |
6277 % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will | |
6278 % also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again. | |
6279 \let\nonarrowing=\relax | |
6280 | |
6281 % @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around | |
6282 % environment contents. | |
6283 \font\circle=lcircle10 | |
6284 \newdimen\circthick | |
6285 \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner | |
6286 \newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip | |
6287 \circthick=\fontdimen8\circle | |
6288 % | |
6289 \def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth | |
6290 \def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}} | |
6291 \def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}} | |
6292 \def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}} | |
6293 \def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip | |
6294 \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr | |
6295 \hskip\rskip}} | |
6296 \def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip | |
6297 \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr | |
6298 \hskip\rskip}} | |
6299 % | |
6300 \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip | |
6301 | |
6302 \envdef\cartouche{% | |
6303 \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph. | |
6304 \startsavinginserts | |
6305 \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip | |
6306 \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*. | |
6307 \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip | |
6308 \advance\cartinner by-\rskip | |
6309 \cartouter=\hsize | |
6310 \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either | |
6311 % side, and for 6pt waste from | |
6312 % each corner char, and rule thickness | |
6313 \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip | |
6314 % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin. | |
6315 \let\nonarrowing = t% | |
6316 % | |
6317 % If this cartouche directly follows a sectioning command, we need the | |
6318 % \parskip glue (backspaced over by default) or the cartouche can | |
6319 % collide with the section heading. | |
6320 \ifnum\lastpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \penalty\lastpenalty \fi | |
6321 % | |
6322 \vbox\bgroup | |
6323 \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt | |
6324 \carttop | |
6325 \hbox\bgroup | |
6326 \hskip\lskip | |
6327 \vrule\kern3pt | |
6328 \vbox\bgroup | |
6329 \kern3pt | |
6330 \hsize=\cartinner | |
6331 \baselineskip=\normbskip | |
6332 \lineskip=\normlskip | |
6333 \parskip=\normpskip | |
6334 \vskip -\parskip | |
6335 \comment % For explanation, see the end of def\group. | |
6336 } | |
6337 \def\Ecartouche{% | |
6338 \ifhmode\par\fi | |
6339 \kern3pt | |
6340 \egroup | |
6341 \kern3pt\vrule | |
6342 \hskip\rskip | |
6343 \egroup | |
6344 \cartbot | |
6345 \egroup | |
6346 \checkinserts | |
6347 } | |
6348 | |
6349 | |
6350 % This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants, | |
6351 % inside a group. | |
6352 \newdimen\nonfillparindent | |
6353 \def\nonfillstart{% | |
6354 \aboveenvbreak | |
6355 \hfuzz = 12pt % Don't be fussy | |
6356 \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens. | |
6357 \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines | |
6358 \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output | |
6359 \parskip = 0pt | |
6360 % Turn off paragraph indentation but redefine \indent to emulate | |
6361 % the normal \indent. | |
6362 \nonfillparindent=\parindent | |
6363 \parindent = 0pt | |
6364 \let\indent\nonfillindent | |
6365 % | |
6366 \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes | |
6367 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax | |
6368 \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing | |
6369 \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing | |
6370 \else | |
6371 \let\nonarrowing = \relax | |
6372 \fi | |
6373 \let\exdent=\nofillexdent | |
6374 } | |
6375 | |
6376 \begingroup | |
6377 \obeyspaces | |
6378 % We want to swallow spaces (but not other tokens) after the fake | |
6379 % @indent in our nonfill-environments, where spaces are normally | |
6380 % active and set to @tie, resulting in them not being ignored after | |
6381 % @indent. | |
6382 \gdef\nonfillindent{\futurelet\temp\nonfillindentcheck}% | |
6383 \gdef\nonfillindentcheck{% | |
6384 \ifx\temp % | |
6385 \expandafter\nonfillindentgobble% | |
6386 \else% | |
6387 \leavevmode\nonfillindentbox% | |
6388 \fi% | |
6389 }% | |
6390 \endgroup | |
6391 \def\nonfillindentgobble#1{\nonfillindent} | |
6392 \def\nonfillindentbox{\hbox to \nonfillparindent{\hss}} | |
6393 | |
6394 % If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small. | |
6395 % If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall. | |
6396 % This affects the following displayed environments: | |
6397 % @example, @display, @format, @lisp | |
6398 % | |
6399 \def\smallword{small} | |
6400 \def\nosmallword{nosmall} | |
6401 \let\SETdispenvsize\relax | |
6402 \def\setnormaldispenv{% | |
6403 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword | |
6404 % end paragraph for sake of leading, in case document has no blank | |
6405 % line. This is redundant with what happens in \aboveenvbreak, but | |
6406 % we need to do it before changing the fonts, and it's inconvenient | |
6407 % to change the fonts afterward. | |
6408 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi | |
6409 \smallexamplefonts \rm | |
6410 \fi | |
6411 } | |
6412 \def\setsmalldispenv{% | |
6413 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword | |
6414 \else | |
6415 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi | |
6416 \smallexamplefonts \rm | |
6417 \fi | |
6418 } | |
6419 | |
6420 % We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo. | |
6421 % Let's do it in one command. #1 is the env name, #2 the definition. | |
6422 \def\makedispenvdef#1#2{% | |
6423 \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}% | |
6424 \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}% | |
6425 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak | |
6426 \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak | |
6427 } | |
6428 | |
6429 % Define two environment synonyms (#1 and #2) for an environment. | |
6430 \def\maketwodispenvdef#1#2#3{% | |
6431 \makedispenvdef{#1}{#3}% | |
6432 \makedispenvdef{#2}{#3}% | |
6433 } | |
6434 % | |
6435 % @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font; | |
6436 % @example: same as @lisp. | |
6437 % | |
6438 % @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts. | |
6439 % Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox. | |
6440 % | |
6441 \maketwodispenvdef{lisp}{example}{% | |
6442 \nonfillstart | |
6443 \tt\setupmarkupstyle{example}% | |
6444 \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special. | |
6445 \gobble % eat return | |
6446 } | |
6447 % @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font. | |
6448 % | |
6449 \makedispenvdef{display}{% | |
6450 \nonfillstart | |
6451 \gobble | |
6452 } | |
6453 | |
6454 % @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins. | |
6455 % | |
6456 \makedispenvdef{format}{% | |
6457 \let\nonarrowing = t% | |
6458 \nonfillstart | |
6459 \gobble | |
6460 } | |
6461 | |
6462 % @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize. | |
6463 \envdef\flushleft{% | |
6464 \let\nonarrowing = t% | |
6465 \nonfillstart | |
6466 \gobble | |
6467 } | |
6468 \let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak | |
6469 | |
6470 % @flushright. | |
6471 % | |
6472 \envdef\flushright{% | |
6473 \let\nonarrowing = t% | |
6474 \nonfillstart | |
6475 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill\relax | |
6476 \gobble | |
6477 } | |
6478 \let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak | |
6479 | |
6480 | |
6481 % @raggedright does more-or-less normal line breaking but no right | |
6482 % justification. From plain.tex. | |
6483 \envdef\raggedright{% | |
6484 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax | |
6485 } | |
6486 \let\Eraggedright\par | |
6487 | |
6488 \envdef\raggedleft{% | |
6489 \parindent=0pt \leftskip0pt plus2em | |
6490 \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt | |
6491 \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off | |
6492 % badness reporting. | |
6493 } | |
6494 \let\Eraggedleft\par | |
6495 | |
6496 \envdef\raggedcenter{% | |
6497 \parindent=0pt \rightskip0pt plus1em \leftskip0pt plus1em | |
6498 \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt | |
6499 \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off | |
6500 % badness reporting. | |
6501 } | |
6502 \let\Eraggedcenter\par | |
6503 | |
6504 | |
6505 % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart) | |
6506 % and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since | |
6507 % we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and | |
6508 % \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0. | |
6509 % | |
6510 \makedispenvdef{quotation}{\quotationstart} | |
6511 % | |
6512 \def\quotationstart{% | |
6513 {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip | |
6514 \parindent=0pt | |
6515 % | |
6516 % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down. | |
6517 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax | |
6518 \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing | |
6519 \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing | |
6520 \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing | |
6521 \else | |
6522 \let\nonarrowing = \relax | |
6523 \fi | |
6524 \parsearg\quotationlabel | |
6525 } | |
6526 | |
6527 % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're | |
6528 % doing normal filling. | |
6529 % | |
6530 \def\Equotation{% | |
6531 \par | |
6532 \ifx\quotationauthor\thisisundefined\else | |
6533 % indent a bit. | |
6534 \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}% | |
6535 \fi | |
6536 {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}% | |
6537 } | |
6538 \def\Esmallquotation{\Equotation} | |
6539 | |
6540 % If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after. | |
6541 \def\quotationlabel#1{% | |
6542 \def\temp{#1}% | |
6543 \ifx\temp\empty \else | |
6544 {\bf #1: }% | |
6545 \fi | |
6546 } | |
6547 | |
6548 | |
6549 % LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>} | |
6550 % If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter, | |
6551 % we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg: | |
6552 % `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org | |
6553 % | |
6554 % [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook. | |
6555 % | |
6556 % [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets | |
6557 % active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a | |
6558 % verbatim line. | |
6559 \def\dospecials{% | |
6560 \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&% | |
6561 \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~% | |
6562 \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"% | |
6563 % Don't do the quotes -- if we do, @set txicodequoteundirected and | |
6564 % @set txicodequotebacktick will not have effect on @verb and | |
6565 % @verbatim, and ?` and !` ligatures won't get disabled. | |
6566 %\do\`\do\'% | |
6567 } | |
6568 % | |
6569 % [Knuth] p. 380 | |
6570 \def\uncatcodespecials{% | |
6571 \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials} | |
6572 % | |
6573 % Setup for the @verb command. | |
6574 % | |
6575 % Eight spaces for a tab | |
6576 \begingroup | |
6577 \catcode`\^^I=\active | |
6578 \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }} | |
6579 \endgroup | |
6580 % | |
6581 \def\setupverb{% | |
6582 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim | |
6583 \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}% | |
6584 \setupmarkupstyle{verb}% | |
6585 \tabeightspaces | |
6586 % Respect line breaks, | |
6587 % print special symbols as themselves, and | |
6588 % make each space count | |
6589 % must do in this order: | |
6590 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces | |
6591 } | |
6592 | |
6593 % Setup for the @verbatim environment | |
6594 % | |
6595 % Real tab expansion. | |
6596 \newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount | |
6597 % | |
6598 % We typeset each line of the verbatim in an \hbox, so we can handle | |
6599 % tabs. The \global is in case the verbatim line starts with an accent, | |
6600 % or some other command that starts with a begin-group. Otherwise, the | |
6601 % entire \verbbox would disappear at the corresponding end-group, before | |
6602 % it is typeset. Meanwhile, we can't have nested verbatim commands | |
6603 % (can we?), so the \global won't be overwriting itself. | |
6604 \newbox\verbbox | |
6605 \def\starttabbox{\global\setbox\verbbox=\hbox\bgroup} | |
6606 % | |
6607 \begingroup | |
6608 \catcode`\^^I=\active | |
6609 \gdef\tabexpand{% | |
6610 \catcode`\^^I=\active | |
6611 \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup | |
6612 \dimen\verbbox=\wd\verbbox % the width so far, or since the previous tab | |
6613 \divide\dimen\verbbox by\tabw | |
6614 \multiply\dimen\verbbox by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw | |
6615 \advance\dimen\verbbox by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw | |
6616 \wd\verbbox=\dimen\verbbox \box\verbbox \starttabbox | |
6617 }% | |
6618 } | |
6619 \endgroup | |
6620 | |
6621 % start the verbatim environment. | |
6622 \def\setupverbatim{% | |
6623 \let\nonarrowing = t% | |
6624 \nonfillstart | |
6625 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim | |
6626 % The \leavevmode here is for blank lines. Otherwise, we would | |
6627 % never \starttabox and the \egroup would end verbatim mode. | |
6628 \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box\verbbox\endgraf}% | |
6629 \tabexpand | |
6630 \setupmarkupstyle{verbatim}% | |
6631 % Respect line breaks, | |
6632 % print special symbols as themselves, and | |
6633 % make each space count. | |
6634 % Must do in this order: | |
6635 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces | |
6636 \everypar{\starttabbox}% | |
6637 } | |
6638 | |
6639 % Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique | |
6640 % delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a | |
6641 % right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace: | |
6642 % | |
6643 % \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1} | |
6644 % | |
6645 % [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {} | |
6646 \begingroup | |
6647 \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other | |
6648 \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next] | |
6649 \endgroup | |
6650 % | |
6651 \def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb} | |
6652 % | |
6653 % | |
6654 % Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that | |
6655 % the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie: | |
6656 % | |
6657 % \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1} | |
6658 % | |
6659 % For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX, | |
6660 % because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}': | |
6661 % we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'. | |
6662 % | |
6663 % Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx] | |
6664 % | |
6665 \begingroup | |
6666 \catcode`\ =\active | |
6667 \obeylines % | |
6668 % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end | |
6669 % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank | |
6670 % line in the output. | |
6671 \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}% | |
6672 % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but | |
6673 % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble. | |
6674 \endgroup | |
6675 % | |
6676 \envdef\verbatim{% | |
6677 \setupverbatim\doverbatim | |
6678 } | |
6679 \let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak | |
6680 | |
6681 | |
6682 % @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment. | |
6683 % | |
6684 \def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude} | |
6685 % | |
6686 \def\doverbatiminclude#1{% | |
6687 {% | |
6688 \makevalueexpandable | |
6689 \setupverbatim | |
6690 \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names. | |
6691 \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @verbatiminclude of #1^^J}% | |
6692 \input #1 | |
6693 \afterenvbreak | |
6694 }% | |
6695 } | |
6696 | |
6697 % @copying ... @end copying. | |
6698 % Save the text away for @insertcopying later. | |
6699 % | |
6700 % We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box. | |
6701 % Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the | |
6702 % typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done | |
6703 % beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source | |
6704 % file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as | |
6705 % possible is very desirable. | |
6706 % | |
6707 \def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying} | |
6708 \def\docopying#1@end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}} | |
6709 % | |
6710 \def\insertcopying{% | |
6711 \begingroup | |
6712 \parindent = 0pt % paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page | |
6713 \scanexp\copyingtext | |
6714 \endgroup | |
6715 } | |
6716 | |
6717 | |
6718 \message{defuns,} | |
6719 % @defun etc. | |
6720 | |
6721 \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in | |
6722 \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt | |
6723 \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt | |
6724 \newcount\defunpenalty | |
6725 | |
6726 % Start the processing of @deffn: | |
6727 \def\startdefun{% | |
6728 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 | |
6729 \medbreak | |
6730 \defunpenalty=10003 % Will keep this @deffn together with the | |
6731 % following @def command, see below. | |
6732 \else | |
6733 % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak, | |
6734 % which is there to keep the function description together with its | |
6735 % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a | |
6736 % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted | |
6737 % by \printdefunline, instead of 10000, since the sectioning | |
6738 % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow | |
6739 % a break between a section heading and a defun. | |
6740 % | |
6741 % As a further refinement, we avoid "club" headers by signalling | |
6742 % with penalty of 10003 after the very first @deffn in the | |
6743 % sequence (see above), and penalty of 10002 after any following | |
6744 % @def command. | |
6745 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi | |
6746 % | |
6747 % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break. | |
6748 % But do insert the glue. | |
6749 \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint | |
6750 \fi | |
6751 % | |
6752 \parindent=0in | |
6753 \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent | |
6754 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent | |
6755 } | |
6756 | |
6757 \def\dodefunx#1{% | |
6758 % First, check whether we are in the right environment: | |
6759 \checkenv#1% | |
6760 % | |
6761 % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row. | |
6762 % It's not a great place, though. | |
6763 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi | |
6764 % | |
6765 % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun: | |
6766 \expandafter\gobbledefun#1% | |
6767 } | |
6768 \def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{} | |
6769 | |
6770 % \printdefunline \deffnheader{text} | |
6771 % | |
6772 \def\printdefunline#1#2{% | |
6773 \begingroup | |
6774 % call \deffnheader: | |
6775 #1#2 \endheader | |
6776 % common ending: | |
6777 \interlinepenalty = 10000 | |
6778 \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil\relax | |
6779 \endgraf | |
6780 \nobreak\vskip -\parskip | |
6781 \penalty\defunpenalty % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx | |
6782 % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses, | |
6783 % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize. | |
6784 \checkparencounts | |
6785 \endgroup | |
6786 } | |
6787 | |
6788 \def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak} | |
6789 | |
6790 % \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn; | |
6791 % the only thing remaining is to define \deffnheader. | |
6792 % | |
6793 \def\makedefun#1{% | |
6794 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun | |
6795 \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun | |
6796 \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}% | |
6797 \temp | |
6798 } | |
6799 | |
6800 % \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader | |
6801 % | |
6802 % Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters. | |
6803 % \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly. | |
6804 % | |
6805 \def\domakedefun#1#2#3{% | |
6806 \envdef#1{% | |
6807 \startdefun | |
6808 \doingtypefnfalse % distinguish typed functions from all else | |
6809 \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}% | |
6810 }% | |
6811 \def#2{\dodefunx#1}% | |
6812 \def#3% | |
6813 } | |
6814 | |
6815 \newif\ifdoingtypefn % doing typed function? | |
6816 \newif\ifrettypeownline % typeset return type on its own line? | |
6817 | |
6818 % @deftypefnnewline on|off says whether the return type of typed functions | |
6819 % are printed on their own line. This affects @deftypefn, @deftypefun, | |
6820 % @deftypeop, and @deftypemethod. | |
6821 % | |
6822 \parseargdef\deftypefnnewline{% | |
6823 \def\temp{#1}% | |
6824 \ifx\temp\onword | |
6825 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname | |
6826 = \empty | |
6827 \else\ifx\temp\offword | |
6828 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname | |
6829 = \relax | |
6830 \else | |
6831 \errhelp = \EMsimple | |
6832 \errmessage{Unknown @txideftypefnnl value `\temp', | |
6833 must be on|off}% | |
6834 \fi\fi | |
6835 } | |
6836 | |
6837 % Untyped functions: | |
6838 | |
6839 % @deffn category name args | |
6840 \makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}} | |
6841 | |
6842 % @deffn category class name args | |
6843 \makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}} | |
6844 | |
6845 % \defopon {category on}class name args | |
6846 \def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} } | |
6847 | |
6848 % \deffngeneral {subind}category name args | |
6849 % | |
6850 \def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{% | |
6851 % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}. | |
6852 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}% | |
6853 \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}% | |
6854 } | |
6855 | |
6856 % Typed functions: | |
6857 | |
6858 % @deftypefn category type name args | |
6859 \makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}} | |
6860 | |
6861 % @deftypeop category class type name args | |
6862 \makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}} | |
6863 | |
6864 % \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args | |
6865 \def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} } | |
6866 | |
6867 % \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args | |
6868 % | |
6869 \def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{% | |
6870 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}% | |
6871 \doingtypefntrue | |
6872 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}% | |
6873 } | |
6874 | |
6875 % Typed variables: | |
6876 | |
6877 % @deftypevr category type var args | |
6878 \makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}} | |
6879 | |
6880 % @deftypecv category class type var args | |
6881 \makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}} | |
6882 | |
6883 % \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args | |
6884 \def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} } | |
6885 | |
6886 % \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args | |
6887 % | |
6888 \def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{% | |
6889 \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}% | |
6890 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}% | |
6891 } | |
6892 | |
6893 % Untyped variables: | |
6894 | |
6895 % @defvr category var args | |
6896 \makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} } | |
6897 | |
6898 % @defcv category class var args | |
6899 \makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}} | |
6900 | |
6901 % \defcvof {category of}class var args | |
6902 \def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} } | |
6903 | |
6904 % Types: | |
6905 | |
6906 % @deftp category name args | |
6907 \makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{% | |
6908 \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}% | |
6909 \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}% | |
6910 } | |
6911 | |
6912 % Remaining @defun-like shortcuts: | |
6913 \makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} } | |
6914 \makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} } | |
6915 \makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} } | |
6916 \makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} } | |
6917 \makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} } | |
6918 \makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} } | |
6919 \makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} } | |
6920 \makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon} | |
6921 \makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon} | |
6922 \makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof} | |
6923 \makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof} | |
6924 | |
6925 % \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args). | |
6926 % #1 is the category, such as "Function". | |
6927 % #2 is the return type, if any. | |
6928 % #3 is the function name. | |
6929 % | |
6930 % We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any. | |
6931 % | |
6932 \def\defname#1#2#3{% | |
6933 \par | |
6934 % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def... | |
6935 \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent | |
6936 % | |
6937 % Determine if we are typesetting the return type of a typed function | |
6938 % on a line by itself. | |
6939 \rettypeownlinefalse | |
6940 \ifdoingtypefn % doing a typed function specifically? | |
6941 % then check user option for putting return type on its own line: | |
6942 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname\relax \else | |
6943 \rettypeownlinetrue | |
6944 \fi | |
6945 \fi | |
6946 % | |
6947 % How we'll format the category name. Putting it in brackets helps | |
6948 % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line | |
6949 % just below it. | |
6950 \def\temp{#1}% | |
6951 \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi} | |
6952 % | |
6953 % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape. We'll always have at | |
6954 % least two. | |
6955 \tempnum = 2 | |
6956 % | |
6957 % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero, | |
6958 % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it: | |
6959 \dimen0=\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip | |
6960 % | |
6961 % If doing a return type on its own line, we'll have another line. | |
6962 \ifrettypeownline | |
6963 \advance\tempnum by 1 | |
6964 \def\maybeshapeline{0in \hsize}% | |
6965 \else | |
6966 \def\maybeshapeline{}% | |
6967 \fi | |
6968 % | |
6969 % The continuations: | |
6970 \dimen2=\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent | |
6971 % | |
6972 % The final paragraph shape: | |
6973 \parshape \tempnum 0in \dimen0 \maybeshapeline \defargsindent \dimen2 | |
6974 % | |
6975 % Put the category name at the right margin. | |
6976 \noindent | |
6977 \hbox to 0pt{% | |
6978 \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize | |
6979 % \hsize has to be shortened this way: | |
6980 \kern\leftskip | |
6981 % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space. | |
6982 }% | |
6983 % | |
6984 % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint: | |
6985 \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000 | |
6986 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent | |
6987 {% | |
6988 % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because: | |
6989 % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle. | |
6990 % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's | |
6991 % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in | |
6992 % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm. | |
6993 % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures. | |
6994 % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no | |
6995 % one has made identifiers using them :). | |
6996 \df \tt | |
6997 \def\temp{#2}% text of the return type | |
6998 \ifx\temp\empty\else | |
6999 \tclose{\temp}% typeset the return type | |
7000 \ifrettypeownline | |
7001 % put return type on its own line; prohibit line break following: | |
7002 \hfil\vadjust{\nobreak}\break | |
7003 \else | |
7004 \space % type on same line, so just followed by a space | |
7005 \fi | |
7006 \fi % no return type | |
7007 #3% output function name | |
7008 }% | |
7009 {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm | |
7010 % | |
7011 \boldbrax | |
7012 % arguments will be output next, if any. | |
7013 } | |
7014 | |
7015 % Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using | |
7016 % tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in | |
7017 % the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very | |
7018 % distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars. | |
7019 % | |
7020 \def\defunargs#1{% | |
7021 % use sl by default (not ttsl), | |
7022 % tt for the names. | |
7023 \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0 | |
7024 % | |
7025 % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we | |
7026 % want a way to get ttsl. Let's try @var for that. | |
7027 \def\var##1{{\setupmarkupstyle{var}\ttslanted{##1}}}% | |
7028 #1% | |
7029 \sl\hyphenchar\font=45 | |
7030 } | |
7031 | |
7032 % We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line. | |
7033 % | |
7034 \def\activeparens{% | |
7035 \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active | |
7036 \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active | |
7037 \catcode`\&=\active | |
7038 } | |
7039 | |
7040 % Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars. | |
7041 \let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = ) | |
7042 | |
7043 % Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example, | |
7044 % if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet, | |
7045 % so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence. | |
7046 { | |
7047 \activeparens | |
7048 \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen | |
7049 \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack | |
7050 \global\let& = \& | |
7051 | |
7052 \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb} | |
7053 \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm} | |
7054 } | |
7055 | |
7056 \newcount\parencount | |
7057 | |
7058 % If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards | |
7059 \newif\ifampseen | |
7060 \def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\ }} | |
7061 | |
7062 \def\parenfont{% | |
7063 \ifampseen | |
7064 % At the first level, print parens in roman, | |
7065 % otherwise use the default font. | |
7066 \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi | |
7067 \else | |
7068 % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than | |
7069 % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] . | |
7070 \sf | |
7071 \fi | |
7072 } | |
7073 \def\infirstlevel#1{% | |
7074 \ifampseen | |
7075 \ifnum\parencount=1 | |
7076 #1% | |
7077 \fi | |
7078 \fi | |
7079 } | |
7080 \def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf} | |
7081 | |
7082 \def\opnr{% | |
7083 \global\advance\parencount by 1 | |
7084 {\parenfont(}% | |
7085 \infirstlevel \bfafterword | |
7086 } | |
7087 \def\clnr{% | |
7088 {\parenfont)}% | |
7089 \infirstlevel \sl | |
7090 \global\advance\parencount by -1 | |
7091 } | |
7092 | |
7093 \newcount\brackcount | |
7094 \def\lbrb{% | |
7095 \global\advance\brackcount by 1 | |
7096 {\bf[}% | |
7097 } | |
7098 \def\rbrb{% | |
7099 {\bf]}% | |
7100 \global\advance\brackcount by -1 | |
7101 } | |
7102 | |
7103 \def\checkparencounts{% | |
7104 \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi | |
7105 \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi | |
7106 } | |
7107 % these should not use \errmessage; the glibc manual, at least, actually | |
7108 % has such constructs (when documenting function pointers). | |
7109 \def\badparencount{% | |
7110 \message{Warning: unbalanced parentheses in @def...}% | |
7111 \global\parencount=0 | |
7112 } | |
7113 \def\badbrackcount{% | |
7114 \message{Warning: unbalanced square brackets in @def...}% | |
7115 \global\brackcount=0 | |
7116 } | |
7117 | |
7118 | |
7119 \message{macros,} | |
7120 % @macro. | |
7121 | |
7122 % To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens, | |
7123 % which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX. | |
7124 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined | |
7125 \newwrite\macscribble | |
7126 \def\scantokens#1{% | |
7127 \toks0={#1}% | |
7128 \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp | |
7129 \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}% | |
7130 \immediate\closeout\macscribble | |
7131 \input \jobname.tmp | |
7132 } | |
7133 \fi | |
7134 | |
7135 \def\scanmacro#1{\begingroup | |
7136 \newlinechar`\^^M | |
7137 \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces | |
7138 % | |
7139 % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex | |
7140 % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active | |
7141 % backslash to get it printed correctly. Previously, we had | |
7142 % \catcode`\\=\other instead. We'll see whether a problem appears | |
7143 % with macro expansion. --kasal, 19aug04 | |
7144 \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active \escapechar=`\@ | |
7145 % | |
7146 % ... and for \example: | |
7147 \spaceisspace | |
7148 % | |
7149 % The \empty here causes a following catcode 5 newline to be eaten as | |
7150 % part of reading whitespace after a control sequence. It does not | |
7151 % eat a catcode 13 newline. There's no good way to handle the two | |
7152 % cases (untried: maybe e-TeX's \everyeof could help, though plain TeX | |
7153 % would then have different behavior). See the Macro Details node in | |
7154 % the manual for the workaround we recommend for macros and | |
7155 % line-oriented commands. | |
7156 % | |
7157 \scantokens{#1\empty}% | |
7158 \endgroup} | |
7159 | |
7160 \def\scanexp#1{% | |
7161 \edef\temp{\noexpand\scanmacro{#1}}% | |
7162 \temp | |
7163 } | |
7164 | |
7165 \newcount\paramno % Count of parameters | |
7166 \newtoks\macname % Macro name | |
7167 \newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive? | |
7168 | |
7169 % List of all defined macros in the form | |
7170 % \definedummyword\macro1\definedummyword\macro2... | |
7171 % Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split | |
7172 % if there is a need. | |
7173 \def\macrolist{} | |
7174 | |
7175 % Add the macro to \macrolist | |
7176 \def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname} | |
7177 \def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{% | |
7178 \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\definedummyword#1}% | |
7179 \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}% | |
7180 } | |
7181 | |
7182 % Utility routines. | |
7183 % This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is, | |
7184 % \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname | |
7185 % (except of course we have to play expansion games). | |
7186 % | |
7187 \def\cslet#1#2{% | |
7188 \expandafter\let | |
7189 \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname | |
7190 \csname#2\endcsname | |
7191 } | |
7192 | |
7193 % Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string. | |
7194 % Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN). | |
7195 {\catcode`\@=11 | |
7196 \gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }} | |
7197 \gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@} | |
7198 \gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @} | |
7199 \def\unbrace#1{#1} | |
7200 \unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1} | |
7201 } | |
7202 | |
7203 % Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string. | |
7204 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3% | |
7205 \gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}% | |
7206 \gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}% | |
7207 \gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}% | |
7208 } | |
7209 | |
7210 % Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where | |
7211 % all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active | |
7212 % (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \ | |
7213 % to recognize macro arguments; this is the job of \mbodybackslash. | |
7214 % | |
7215 % Non-ASCII encodings make 8-bit characters active, so un-activate | |
7216 % them to avoid their expansion. Must do this non-globally, to | |
7217 % confine the change to the current group. | |
7218 % | |
7219 % It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is | |
7220 % done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro | |
7221 % body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro. | |
7222 % | |
7223 \def\scanctxt{% used as subroutine | |
7224 \catcode`\"=\other | |
7225 \catcode`\+=\other | |
7226 \catcode`\<=\other | |
7227 \catcode`\>=\other | |
7228 \catcode`\@=\other | |
7229 \catcode`\^=\other | |
7230 \catcode`\_=\other | |
7231 \catcode`\|=\other | |
7232 \catcode`\~=\other | |
7233 \ifx\declaredencoding\ascii \else \setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal\other \fi | |
7234 } | |
7235 | |
7236 \def\scanargctxt{% used for copying and captions, not macros. | |
7237 \scanctxt | |
7238 \catcode`\\=\other | |
7239 \catcode`\^^M=\other | |
7240 } | |
7241 | |
7242 \def\macrobodyctxt{% used for @macro definitions | |
7243 \scanctxt | |
7244 \catcode`\{=\other | |
7245 \catcode`\}=\other | |
7246 \catcode`\^^M=\other | |
7247 \usembodybackslash | |
7248 } | |
7249 | |
7250 \def\macroargctxt{% used when scanning invocations | |
7251 \scanctxt | |
7252 \catcode`\\=0 | |
7253 } | |
7254 % why catcode 0 for \ in the above? To recognize \\ \{ \} as "escapes" | |
7255 % for the single characters \ { }. Thus, we end up with the "commands" | |
7256 % that would be written @\ @{ @} in a Texinfo document. | |
7257 % | |
7258 % We already have @{ and @}. For @\, we define it here, and only for | |
7259 % this purpose, to produce a typewriter backslash (so, the @\ that we | |
7260 % define for @math can't be used with @macro calls): | |
7261 % | |
7262 \def\\{\normalbackslash}% | |
7263 % | |
7264 % We would like to do this for \, too, since that is what makeinfo does. | |
7265 % But it is not possible, because Texinfo already has a command @, for a | |
7266 % cedilla accent. Documents must use @comma{} instead. | |
7267 % | |
7268 % \anythingelse will almost certainly be an error of some kind. | |
7269 | |
7270 | |
7271 % \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies. | |
7272 % It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N | |
7273 % where N is the macro parameter number. | |
7274 % We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so | |
7275 % \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash. | |
7276 % | |
7277 {\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active | |
7278 @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash} | |
7279 @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname} | |
7280 } | |
7281 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash} | |
7282 | |
7283 \def\margbackslash#1{\char`\#1 } | |
7284 | |
7285 \def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx} | |
7286 \def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx} | |
7287 | |
7288 \def\macroxxx#1{% | |
7289 \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist | |
7290 \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments | |
7291 \paramno=0\relax | |
7292 \else | |
7293 \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;% | |
7294 \if\paramno>256\relax | |
7295 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined | |
7296 \errhelp = \EMsimple | |
7297 \errmessage{You need eTeX to compile a file with macros with more than 256 arguments} | |
7298 \fi | |
7299 \fi | |
7300 \fi | |
7301 \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname | |
7302 \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}% | |
7303 \else | |
7304 \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax | |
7305 \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi | |
7306 \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}% | |
7307 \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1% | |
7308 \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}% | |
7309 \fi | |
7310 \begingroup \macrobodyctxt | |
7311 \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody | |
7312 \else \expandafter\parsemacbody | |
7313 \fi} | |
7314 | |
7315 \parseargdef\unmacro{% | |
7316 \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname | |
7317 \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}% | |
7318 \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0% | |
7319 % Remove the macro name from \macrolist: | |
7320 \begingroup | |
7321 \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax | |
7322 \let\definedummyword\unmacrodo | |
7323 \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}% | |
7324 \endgroup | |
7325 \else | |
7326 \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}% | |
7327 \fi | |
7328 } | |
7329 | |
7330 % Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any | |
7331 % macro definitions that have been changed to \relax. | |
7332 % | |
7333 \def\unmacrodo#1{% | |
7334 \ifx #1\relax | |
7335 % remove this | |
7336 \else | |
7337 \noexpand\definedummyword \noexpand#1% | |
7338 \fi | |
7339 } | |
7340 | |
7341 % This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a | |
7342 % <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by | |
7343 % an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed. | |
7344 \def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}} | |
7345 \def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs} | |
7346 \def\getmacname#1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}} | |
7347 \def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}} | |
7348 | |
7349 % For macro processing make @ a letter so that we can make Texinfo private macro names. | |
7350 \edef\texiatcatcode{\the\catcode`\@} | |
7351 \catcode `@=11\relax | |
7352 | |
7353 % Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist | |
7354 % so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.BLAH for each BLAH | |
7355 % in the params list to some hook where the argument si to be expanded. If | |
7356 % there are less than 10 arguments that hook is to be replaced by ##N where N | |
7357 % is the position in that list, that is to say the macro arguments are to be | |
7358 % defined `a la TeX in the macro body. | |
7359 % | |
7360 % That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above). | |
7361 % | |
7362 % We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions. | |
7363 % The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something | |
7364 % unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine | |
7365 % it to # just before using the token list produced. | |
7366 % | |
7367 % The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before | |
7368 % the macro is used. | |
7369 % | |
7370 % If there are 10 or more arguments, a different technique is used, where the | |
7371 % hook remains in the body, and when macro is to be expanded the body is | |
7372 % processed again to replace the arguments. | |
7373 % | |
7374 % In that case, the hook is \the\toks N-1, and we simply set \toks N-1 to the | |
7375 % argument N value and then \edef the body (nothing else will expand because of | |
7376 % the catcode regime underwhich the body was input). | |
7377 % | |
7378 % If you compile with TeX (not eTeX), and you have macros with 10 or more | |
7379 % arguments, you need that no macro has more than 256 arguments, otherwise an | |
7380 % error is produced. | |
7381 \def\parsemargdef#1;{% | |
7382 \paramno=0\def\paramlist{}% | |
7383 \let\hash\relax | |
7384 \let\xeatspaces\relax | |
7385 \parsemargdefxxx#1,;,% | |
7386 % In case that there are 10 or more arguments we parse again the arguments | |
7387 % list to set new definitions for the \macarg.BLAH macros corresponding to | |
7388 % each BLAH argument. It was anyhow needed to parse already once this list | |
7389 % in order to count the arguments, and as macros with at most 9 arguments | |
7390 % are by far more frequent than macro with 10 or more arguments, defining | |
7391 % twice the \macarg.BLAH macros does not cost too much processing power. | |
7392 \ifnum\paramno<10\relax\else | |
7393 \paramno0\relax | |
7394 \parsemmanyargdef@@#1,;,% 10 or more arguments | |
7395 \fi | |
7396 } | |
7397 \def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{% | |
7398 \if#1;\let\next=\relax | |
7399 \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx | |
7400 \advance\paramno by 1 | |
7401 \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname | |
7402 {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}% | |
7403 \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}% | |
7404 \fi\next} | |
7405 | |
7406 \def\parsemmanyargdef@@#1,{% | |
7407 \if#1;\let\next=\relax | |
7408 \else | |
7409 \let\next=\parsemmanyargdef@@ | |
7410 \edef\tempb{\eatspaces{#1}}% | |
7411 \expandafter\def\expandafter\tempa | |
7412 \expandafter{\csname macarg.\tempb\endcsname}% | |
7413 % Note that we need some extra \noexpand\noexpand, this is because we | |
7414 % don't want \the to be expanded in the \parsermacbody as it uses an | |
7415 % \xdef . | |
7416 \expandafter\edef\tempa | |
7417 {\noexpand\noexpand\noexpand\the\toks\the\paramno}% | |
7418 \advance\paramno by 1\relax | |
7419 \fi\next} | |
7420 | |
7421 % These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies. | |
7422 % (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.) | |
7423 % | |
7424 | |
7425 \catcode `\@\texiatcatcode | |
7426 \long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro% | |
7427 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}% | |
7428 \long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro% | |
7429 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}% | |
7430 \catcode `\@=11\relax | |
7431 | |
7432 \let\endargs@\relax | |
7433 \let\nil@\relax | |
7434 \def\nilm@{\nil@}% | |
7435 \long\def\nillm@{\nil@}% | |
7436 | |
7437 % This macro is expanded during the Texinfo macro expansion, not during its | |
7438 % definition. It gets all the arguments values and assigns them to macros | |
7439 % macarg.ARGNAME | |
7440 % | |
7441 % #1 is the macro name | |
7442 % #2 is the list of argument names | |
7443 % #3 is the list of argument values | |
7444 \def\getargvals@#1#2#3{% | |
7445 \def\macargdeflist@{}% | |
7446 \def\saveparamlist@{#2}% Need to keep a copy for parameter expansion. | |
7447 \def\paramlist{#2,\nil@}% | |
7448 \def\macroname{#1}% | |
7449 \begingroup | |
7450 \macroargctxt | |
7451 \def\argvaluelist{#3,\nil@}% | |
7452 \def\@tempa{#3}% | |
7453 \ifx\@tempa\empty | |
7454 \setemptyargvalues@ | |
7455 \else | |
7456 \getargvals@@ | |
7457 \fi | |
7458 } | |
7459 | |
7460 % | |
7461 \def\getargvals@@{% | |
7462 \ifx\paramlist\nilm@ | |
7463 % Some sanity check needed here that \argvaluelist is also empty. | |
7464 \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@ | |
7465 \else | |
7466 \errhelp = \EMsimple | |
7467 \errmessage{Too many arguments in macro `\macroname'!}% | |
7468 \fi | |
7469 \let\next\macargexpandinbody@ | |
7470 \else | |
7471 \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@ | |
7472 % No more arguments values passed to macro. Set remaining named-arg | |
7473 % macros to empty. | |
7474 \let\next\setemptyargvalues@ | |
7475 \else | |
7476 % pop current arg name into \@tempb | |
7477 \def\@tempa##1{\pop@{\@tempb}{\paramlist}##1\endargs@}% | |
7478 \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\paramlist}% | |
7479 % pop current argument value into \@tempc | |
7480 \def\@tempa##1{\longpop@{\@tempc}{\argvaluelist}##1\endargs@}% | |
7481 \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\argvaluelist}% | |
7482 % Here \@tempb is the current arg name and \@tempc is the current arg value. | |
7483 % First place the new argument macro definition into \@tempd | |
7484 \expandafter\macname\expandafter{\@tempc}% | |
7485 \expandafter\let\csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname\relax | |
7486 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempe\expandafter{% | |
7487 \csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname}% | |
7488 \edef\@tempd{\long\def\@tempe{\the\macname}}% | |
7489 \push@\@tempd\macargdeflist@ | |
7490 \let\next\getargvals@@ | |
7491 \fi | |
7492 \fi | |
7493 \next | |
7494 } | |
7495 | |
7496 \def\push@#1#2{% | |
7497 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\def | |
7498 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter#2% | |
7499 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter{% | |
7500 \expandafter#1#2}% | |
7501 } | |
7502 | |
7503 % Replace arguments by their values in the macro body, and place the result | |
7504 % in macro \@tempa | |
7505 \def\macvalstoargs@{% | |
7506 % To do this we use the property that token registers that are \the'ed | |
7507 % within an \edef expand only once. So we are going to place all argument | |
7508 % values into respective token registers. | |
7509 % | |
7510 % First we save the token context, and initialize argument numbering. | |
7511 \begingroup | |
7512 \paramno0\relax | |
7513 % Then, for each argument number #N, we place the corresponding argument | |
7514 % value into a new token list register \toks#N | |
7515 \expandafter\putargsintokens@\saveparamlist@,;,% | |
7516 % Then, we expand the body so that argument are replaced by their | |
7517 % values. The trick for values not to be expanded themselves is that they | |
7518 % are within tokens and that tokens expand only once in an \edef . | |
7519 \edef\@tempc{\csname mac.\macroname .body\endcsname}% | |
7520 % Now we restore the token stack pointer to free the token list registers | |
7521 % which we have used, but we make sure that expanded body is saved after | |
7522 % group. | |
7523 \expandafter | |
7524 \endgroup | |
7525 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\@tempc}% | |
7526 } | |
7527 | |
7528 \def\macargexpandinbody@{% | |
7529 %% Define the named-macro outside of this group and then close this group. | |
7530 \expandafter | |
7531 \endgroup | |
7532 \macargdeflist@ | |
7533 % First the replace in body the macro arguments by their values, the result | |
7534 % is in \@tempa . | |
7535 \macvalstoargs@ | |
7536 % Then we point at the \norecurse or \gobble (for recursive) macro value | |
7537 % with \@tempb . | |
7538 \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempb\csname mac.\macroname .recurse\endcsname | |
7539 % Depending on whether it is recursive or not, we need some tailing | |
7540 % \egroup . | |
7541 \ifx\@tempb\gobble | |
7542 \let\@tempc\relax | |
7543 \else | |
7544 \let\@tempc\egroup | |
7545 \fi | |
7546 % And now we do the real job: | |
7547 \edef\@tempd{\noexpand\@tempb{\macroname}\noexpand\scanmacro{\@tempa}\@tempc}% | |
7548 \@tempd | |
7549 } | |
7550 | |
7551 \def\putargsintokens@#1,{% | |
7552 \if#1;\let\next\relax | |
7553 \else | |
7554 \let\next\putargsintokens@ | |
7555 % First we allocate the new token list register, and give it a temporary | |
7556 % alias \@tempb . | |
7557 \toksdef\@tempb\the\paramno | |
7558 % Then we place the argument value into that token list register. | |
7559 \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempa\csname macarg.#1\endcsname | |
7560 \expandafter\@tempb\expandafter{\@tempa}% | |
7561 \advance\paramno by 1\relax | |
7562 \fi | |
7563 \next | |
7564 } | |
7565 | |
7566 % Save the token stack pointer into macro #1 | |
7567 \def\texisavetoksstackpoint#1{\edef#1{\the\@cclvi}} | |
7568 % Restore the token stack pointer from number in macro #1 | |
7569 \def\texirestoretoksstackpoint#1{\expandafter\mathchardef\expandafter\@cclvi#1\relax} | |
7570 % newtoks that can be used non \outer . | |
7571 \def\texinonouternewtoks{\alloc@ 5\toks \toksdef \@cclvi} | |
7572 | |
7573 % Tailing missing arguments are set to empty | |
7574 \def\setemptyargvalues@{% | |
7575 \ifx\paramlist\nilm@ | |
7576 \let\next\macargexpandinbody@ | |
7577 \else | |
7578 \expandafter\setemptyargvaluesparser@\paramlist\endargs@ | |
7579 \let\next\setemptyargvalues@ | |
7580 \fi | |
7581 \next | |
7582 } | |
7583 | |
7584 \def\setemptyargvaluesparser@#1,#2\endargs@{% | |
7585 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{% | |
7586 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.#1\endcsname{}}% | |
7587 \push@\@tempa\macargdeflist@ | |
7588 \def\paramlist{#2}% | |
7589 } | |
7590 | |
7591 % #1 is the element target macro | |
7592 % #2 is the list macro | |
7593 % #3,#4\endargs@ is the list value | |
7594 \def\pop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{% | |
7595 \def#1{#3}% | |
7596 \def#2{#4}% | |
7597 } | |
7598 \long\def\longpop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{% | |
7599 \long\def#1{#3}% | |
7600 \long\def#2{#4}% | |
7601 } | |
7602 | |
7603 % This defines a Texinfo @macro. There are eight cases: recursive and | |
7604 % nonrecursive macros of zero, one, up to nine, and many arguments. | |
7605 % Much magic with \expandafter here. | |
7606 % \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file | |
7607 % they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group. | |
7608 % | |
7609 \def\defmacro{% | |
7610 \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars | |
7611 \ifrecursive | |
7612 \ifcase\paramno | |
7613 % 0 | |
7614 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% | |
7615 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% | |
7616 \or % 1 | |
7617 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% | |
7618 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt | |
7619 \noexpand\braceorline | |
7620 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}% | |
7621 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{% | |
7622 \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% | |
7623 \else | |
7624 \ifnum\paramno<10\relax % at most 9 | |
7625 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% | |
7626 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt | |
7627 \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}% | |
7628 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{% | |
7629 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}% | |
7630 \expandafter\expandafter | |
7631 \expandafter\xdef | |
7632 \expandafter\expandafter | |
7633 \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname | |
7634 \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% | |
7635 \else % 10 or more | |
7636 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% | |
7637 \noexpand\getargvals@{\the\macname}{\argl}% | |
7638 }% | |
7639 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .body\endcsname\temp | |
7640 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .recurse\endcsname\gobble | |
7641 \fi | |
7642 \fi | |
7643 \else | |
7644 \ifcase\paramno | |
7645 % 0 | |
7646 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% | |
7647 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% | |
7648 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% | |
7649 \or % 1 | |
7650 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% | |
7651 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt | |
7652 \noexpand\braceorline | |
7653 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}% | |
7654 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{% | |
7655 \egroup | |
7656 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% | |
7657 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% | |
7658 \else % at most 9 | |
7659 \ifnum\paramno<10\relax | |
7660 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% | |
7661 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt | |
7662 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}% | |
7663 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{% | |
7664 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}% | |
7665 \expandafter\expandafter | |
7666 \expandafter\xdef | |
7667 \expandafter\expandafter | |
7668 \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname | |
7669 \paramlist{% | |
7670 \egroup | |
7671 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% | |
7672 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% | |
7673 \else % 10 or more: | |
7674 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% | |
7675 \noexpand\getargvals@{\the\macname}{\argl}% | |
7676 }% | |
7677 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .body\endcsname\temp | |
7678 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .recurse\endcsname\norecurse | |
7679 \fi | |
7680 \fi | |
7681 \fi} | |
7682 | |
7683 \catcode `\@\texiatcatcode\relax | |
7684 | |
7685 \def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}} | |
7686 | |
7687 % \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a | |
7688 % {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole | |
7689 % line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence | |
7690 % as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg). | |
7691 % | |
7692 \def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx} | |
7693 \def\braceorlinexxx{% | |
7694 \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else | |
7695 \expandafter\parsearg | |
7696 \fi \macnamexxx} | |
7697 | |
7698 | |
7699 % @alias. | |
7700 % We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal | |
7701 % sign. Make them active and then expand them all to nothing. | |
7702 % | |
7703 \def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx} | |
7704 \def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax} | |
7705 \def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{% | |
7706 {% | |
7707 \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty | |
7708 \addtomacrolist{#1}% | |
7709 \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}% | |
7710 }% | |
7711 \next | |
7712 } | |
7713 | |
7714 | |
7715 \message{cross references,} | |
7716 | |
7717 \newwrite\auxfile | |
7718 \newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known. | |
7719 \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known. | |
7720 | |
7721 % @inforef is relatively simple. | |
7722 \def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**} | |
7723 \def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{% | |
7724 \putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}}, | |
7725 node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}} | |
7726 | |
7727 % @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in | |
7728 % cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and | |
7729 % might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like: | |
7730 % @node foo , bar , ... | |
7731 % We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name. | |
7732 % | |
7733 \parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,\finishnodeparse} | |
7734 % | |
7735 % also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this: | |
7736 % @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs | |
7737 \def\donode#1 ,#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,\finishnodeparse} | |
7738 \def\dodonode#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}} | |
7739 | |
7740 \let\nwnode=\node | |
7741 \let\lastnode=\empty | |
7742 | |
7743 % Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the | |
7744 % type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing). | |
7745 % | |
7746 \def\donoderef#1{% | |
7747 \ifx\lastnode\empty\else | |
7748 \setref{\lastnode}{#1}% | |
7749 \global\let\lastnode=\empty | |
7750 \fi | |
7751 } | |
7752 | |
7753 % @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point. | |
7754 % | |
7755 \newcount\savesfregister | |
7756 % | |
7757 \def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi} | |
7758 \def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi} | |
7759 \def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces} | |
7760 | |
7761 % \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an | |
7762 % anchor), which consists of three parts: | |
7763 % 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \lastsection, | |
7764 % or the anchor name. | |
7765 % 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or | |
7766 % empty for anchors. | |
7767 % 3) NAME-pg - the page number. | |
7768 % | |
7769 % This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of | |
7770 % floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here: | |
7771 % 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats. | |
7772 % | |
7773 \def\setref#1#2{% | |
7774 \pdfmkdest{#1}% | |
7775 \iflinks | |
7776 {% | |
7777 \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them | |
7778 \edef\writexrdef##1##2{% | |
7779 \write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef | |
7780 ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef | |
7781 }% | |
7782 \toks0 = \expandafter{\lastsection}% | |
7783 \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }% | |
7784 \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc. | |
7785 \safewhatsit{\writexrdef{pg}{\folio}}% will be written later, at \shipout | |
7786 }% | |
7787 \fi | |
7788 } | |
7789 | |
7790 % @xrefautosectiontitle on|off says whether @section(ing) names are used | |
7791 % automatically in xrefs, if the third arg is not explicitly specified. | |
7792 % This was provided as a "secret" @set xref-automatic-section-title | |
7793 % variable, now it's official. | |
7794 % | |
7795 \parseargdef\xrefautomaticsectiontitle{% | |
7796 \def\temp{#1}% | |
7797 \ifx\temp\onword | |
7798 \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname | |
7799 = \empty | |
7800 \else\ifx\temp\offword | |
7801 \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname | |
7802 = \relax | |
7803 \else | |
7804 \errhelp = \EMsimple | |
7805 \errmessage{Unknown @xrefautomaticsectiontitle value `\temp', | |
7806 must be on|off}% | |
7807 \fi\fi | |
7808 } | |
7809 | |
7810 | |
7811 % @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is | |
7812 % the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed | |
7813 % node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed | |
7814 % manual. All but the node name can be omitted. | |
7815 % | |
7816 \def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} | |
7817 \def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} | |
7818 \def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} | |
7819 % | |
7820 \newbox\topbox | |
7821 \newbox\printedrefnamebox | |
7822 \newbox\printedmanualbox | |
7823 % | |
7824 \def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup | |
7825 \unsepspaces | |
7826 % | |
7827 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}% | |
7828 \setbox\printedrefnamebox = \hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}% | |
7829 % | |
7830 \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}% | |
7831 \setbox\printedmanualbox = \hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}% | |
7832 % | |
7833 % If the printed reference name (arg #3) was not explicitly given in | |
7834 % the @xref, figure out what we want to use. | |
7835 \ifdim \wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt | |
7836 % No printed node name was explicitly given. | |
7837 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname \relax | |
7838 % Not auto section-title: use node name inside the square brackets. | |
7839 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}% | |
7840 \else | |
7841 % Auto section-title: use chapter/section title inside | |
7842 % the square brackets if we have it. | |
7843 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt | |
7844 % It is in another manual, so we don't have it; use node name. | |
7845 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}% | |
7846 \else | |
7847 \ifhavexrefs | |
7848 % We (should) know the real title if we have the xref values. | |
7849 \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}% | |
7850 \else | |
7851 % Otherwise just copy the Info node name. | |
7852 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}% | |
7853 \fi% | |
7854 \fi | |
7855 \fi | |
7856 \fi | |
7857 % | |
7858 % Make link in pdf output. | |
7859 \ifpdf | |
7860 {\indexnofonts | |
7861 \turnoffactive | |
7862 \makevalueexpandable | |
7863 % This expands tokens, so do it after making catcode changes, so _ | |
7864 % etc. don't get their TeX definitions. | |
7865 \getfilename{#4}% | |
7866 % | |
7867 \edef\pdfxrefdest{#1}% | |
7868 \txiescapepdf\pdfxrefdest | |
7869 % | |
7870 \leavevmode | |
7871 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% | |
7872 \ifnum\filenamelength>0 | |
7873 goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{\pdfxrefdest}% | |
7874 \else | |
7875 goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfxrefdest}}% | |
7876 \fi | |
7877 }% | |
7878 \setcolor{\linkcolor}% | |
7879 \fi | |
7880 % | |
7881 % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2" | |
7882 % instead of "[somenode], p.3". We distinguish them by the | |
7883 % LABEL-title being set to a magic string. | |
7884 {% | |
7885 % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to | |
7886 % include an _ in the xref name, etc. | |
7887 \indexnofonts | |
7888 \turnoffactive | |
7889 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle | |
7890 \csname XR#1-title\endcsname | |
7891 }% | |
7892 \iffloat\Xthisreftitle | |
7893 % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref, | |
7894 % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2". | |
7895 \ifdim\wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt | |
7896 \refx{#1-snt}{}% | |
7897 \else | |
7898 \printedrefname | |
7899 \fi | |
7900 % | |
7901 % if the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append | |
7902 % "in MANUALNAME". | |
7903 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt | |
7904 \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}% | |
7905 \fi | |
7906 \else | |
7907 % node/anchor (non-float) references. | |
7908 % | |
7909 % If we use \unhbox to print the node names, TeX does not insert | |
7910 % empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will not | |
7911 % find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals | |
7912 % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, | |
7913 % this is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name | |
7914 % again, so it is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time. | |
7915 % | |
7916 % Cross-manual reference. Only include the "Section ``foo'' in" if | |
7917 % the foo is neither missing or Top. Thus, @xref{,,,foo,The Foo Manual} | |
7918 % outputs simply "see The Foo Manual". | |
7919 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt | |
7920 % What is the 7sp about? The idea is that we also want to omit | |
7921 % the Section part if we would be printing "Top", since they are | |
7922 % clearly trying to refer to the whole manual. But, this being | |
7923 % TeX, we can't easily compare strings while ignoring the possible | |
7924 % spaces before and after in the input. By adding the arbitrary | |
7925 % 7sp, we make it much less likely that a real node name would | |
7926 % happen to have the same width as "Top" (e.g., in a monospaced font). | |
7927 % I hope it will never happen in practice. | |
7928 % | |
7929 % For the same basic reason, we retypeset the "Top" at every | |
7930 % reference, since the current font is indeterminate. | |
7931 % | |
7932 \setbox\topbox = \hbox{Top\kern7sp}% | |
7933 \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \printedrefname \unskip \kern7sp}% | |
7934 \ifdim \wd2 > 7sp | |
7935 \ifdim \wd2 = \wd\topbox \else | |
7936 \putwordSection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{}\space | |
7937 \fi | |
7938 \fi | |
7939 \cite{\printedmanual}% | |
7940 \else | |
7941 % Reference in this manual. | |
7942 % | |
7943 % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the | |
7944 % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand | |
7945 % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of | |
7946 % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the | |
7947 % printing, back off for the \refx-pg. | |
7948 {\turnoffactive | |
7949 % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for | |
7950 % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be. | |
7951 \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}% | |
7952 \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi | |
7953 }% | |
7954 % output the `[mynode]' via the macro below so it can be overridden. | |
7955 \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname | |
7956 % | |
7957 % But we always want a comma and a space: | |
7958 ,\space | |
7959 % | |
7960 % output the `page 3'. | |
7961 \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}% | |
7962 \fi | |
7963 \fi | |
7964 \endlink | |
7965 \endgroup} | |
7966 | |
7967 % This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref | |
7968 % output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily, | |
7969 % since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly | |
7970 % one that Bob is working on :). | |
7971 % | |
7972 \def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]} | |
7973 | |
7974 % Things referred to by \setref. | |
7975 % | |
7976 \def\Ynothing{} | |
7977 \def\Yomitfromtoc{} | |
7978 \def\Ynumbered{% | |
7979 \ifnum\secno=0 | |
7980 \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno | |
7981 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0 | |
7982 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno | |
7983 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0 | |
7984 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno | |
7985 \else | |
7986 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno | |
7987 \fi\fi\fi | |
7988 } | |
7989 \def\Yappendix{% | |
7990 \ifnum\secno=0 | |
7991 \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}% | |
7992 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0 | |
7993 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno | |
7994 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0 | |
7995 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno | |
7996 \else | |
7997 \putwordSection@tie | |
7998 @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno | |
7999 \fi\fi\fi | |
8000 } | |
8001 | |
8002 % Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME. | |
8003 % If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward. | |
8004 % | |
8005 \def\refx#1#2{% | |
8006 {% | |
8007 \indexnofonts | |
8008 \otherbackslash | |
8009 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX | |
8010 \csname XR#1\endcsname | |
8011 }% | |
8012 \ifx\thisrefX\relax | |
8013 % If not defined, say something at least. | |
8014 \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright | |
8015 \iflinks | |
8016 \ifhavexrefs | |
8017 {\toks0 = {#1}% avoid expansion of possibly-complex value | |
8018 \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `\the\toks0'.}}% | |
8019 \else | |
8020 \ifwarnedxrefs\else | |
8021 \global\warnedxrefstrue | |
8022 \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}% | |
8023 \fi | |
8024 \fi | |
8025 \fi | |
8026 \else | |
8027 % It's defined, so just use it. | |
8028 \thisrefX | |
8029 \fi | |
8030 #2% Output the suffix in any case. | |
8031 } | |
8032 | |
8033 % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Usually it's | |
8034 % just a \def (we prepend XR to the control sequence name to avoid | |
8035 % collisions). But if this is a float type, we have more work to do. | |
8036 % | |
8037 \def\xrdef#1#2{% | |
8038 {% The node name might contain 8-bit characters, which in our current | |
8039 % implementation are changed to commands like @'e. Don't let these | |
8040 % mess up the control sequence name. | |
8041 \indexnofonts | |
8042 \turnoffactive | |
8043 \xdef\safexrefname{#1}% | |
8044 }% | |
8045 % | |
8046 \expandafter\gdef\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref | |
8047 % | |
8048 % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float? | |
8049 \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname | |
8050 % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype. | |
8051 \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist | |
8052 \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname | |
8053 % | |
8054 % Is this the first time we've seen this float type? | |
8055 \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax | |
8056 \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do | |
8057 \else | |
8058 % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list. | |
8059 \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}% | |
8060 \fi | |
8061 % | |
8062 % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE, | |
8063 % for later use in \listoffloats. | |
8064 \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0 | |
8065 {\safexrefname}}% | |
8066 \fi | |
8067 } | |
8068 | |
8069 % Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists. | |
8070 % | |
8071 \def\tryauxfile{% | |
8072 \openin 1 \jobname.aux | |
8073 \ifeof 1 \else | |
8074 \readdatafile{aux}% | |
8075 \global\havexrefstrue | |
8076 \fi | |
8077 \closein 1 | |
8078 } | |
8079 | |
8080 \def\setupdatafile{% | |
8081 \catcode`\^^@=\other | |
8082 \catcode`\^^A=\other | |
8083 \catcode`\^^B=\other | |
8084 \catcode`\^^C=\other | |
8085 \catcode`\^^D=\other | |
8086 \catcode`\^^E=\other | |
8087 \catcode`\^^F=\other | |
8088 \catcode`\^^G=\other | |
8089 \catcode`\^^H=\other | |
8090 \catcode`\^^K=\other | |
8091 \catcode`\^^L=\other | |
8092 \catcode`\^^N=\other | |
8093 \catcode`\^^P=\other | |
8094 \catcode`\^^Q=\other | |
8095 \catcode`\^^R=\other | |
8096 \catcode`\^^S=\other | |
8097 \catcode`\^^T=\other | |
8098 \catcode`\^^U=\other | |
8099 \catcode`\^^V=\other | |
8100 \catcode`\^^W=\other | |
8101 \catcode`\^^X=\other | |
8102 \catcode`\^^Z=\other | |
8103 \catcode`\^^[=\other | |
8104 \catcode`\^^\=\other | |
8105 \catcode`\^^]=\other | |
8106 \catcode`\^^^=\other | |
8107 \catcode`\^^_=\other | |
8108 % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc. | |
8109 % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't | |
8110 % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore, | |
8111 % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^ | |
8112 % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat | |
8113 % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first | |
8114 % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could | |
8115 % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't. | |
8116 % | |
8117 % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat: | |
8118 % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter | |
8119 % and then to call \auxhat in \setq. | |
8120 % | |
8121 \catcode`\^=\other | |
8122 % | |
8123 % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but... | |
8124 \catcode`\~=\other | |
8125 \catcode`\[=\other | |
8126 \catcode`\]=\other | |
8127 \catcode`\"=\other | |
8128 \catcode`\_=\other | |
8129 \catcode`\|=\other | |
8130 \catcode`\<=\other | |
8131 \catcode`\>=\other | |
8132 \catcode`\$=\other | |
8133 \catcode`\#=\other | |
8134 \catcode`\&=\other | |
8135 \catcode`\%=\other | |
8136 \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off | |
8137 % | |
8138 % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \ | |
8139 % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than | |
8140 % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \ | |
8141 % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value* | |
8142 % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that | |
8143 % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for | |
8144 % now. --karl, 15jan04. | |
8145 \catcode`\\=\other | |
8146 % | |
8147 % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters. | |
8148 {% | |
8149 \count1=128 | |
8150 \def\loop{% | |
8151 \catcode\count1=\other | |
8152 \advance\count1 by 1 | |
8153 \ifnum \count1<256 \loop \fi | |
8154 }% | |
8155 }% | |
8156 % | |
8157 % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces. | |
8158 \catcode`\{=1 | |
8159 \catcode`\}=2 | |
8160 \catcode`\@=0 | |
8161 } | |
8162 | |
8163 \def\readdatafile#1{% | |
8164 \begingroup | |
8165 \setupdatafile | |
8166 \input\jobname.#1 | |
8167 \endgroup} | |
8168 | |
8169 | |
8170 \message{insertions,} | |
8171 % including footnotes. | |
8172 | |
8173 \newcount \footnoteno | |
8174 | |
8175 % The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is | |
8176 % vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a | |
8177 % pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is | |
8178 % removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a | |
8179 % space to prevent strange expansion errors.) | |
8180 \def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 } | |
8181 | |
8182 % @footnotestyle is meaningful for Info output only. | |
8183 \let\footnotestyle=\comment | |
8184 | |
8185 {\catcode `\@=11 | |
8186 % | |
8187 % Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain. | |
8188 \gdef\footnote{% | |
8189 \let\indent=\ptexindent | |
8190 \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent | |
8191 \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne | |
8192 \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}% | |
8193 % | |
8194 % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the | |
8195 % extra spacing after we do the footnote number. | |
8196 \let\@sf\empty | |
8197 \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi | |
8198 % | |
8199 % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number. | |
8200 \unskip | |
8201 \thisfootno\@sf | |
8202 \dofootnote | |
8203 }% | |
8204 | |
8205 % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the | |
8206 % footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general. | |
8207 % | |
8208 % Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses | |
8209 % \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when | |
8210 % the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96. | |
8211 % | |
8212 \gdef\dofootnote{% | |
8213 \insert\footins\bgroup | |
8214 % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the | |
8215 % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment. | |
8216 % So reset some parameters. | |
8217 \hsize=\pagewidth | |
8218 \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty | |
8219 \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes | |
8220 \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox | |
8221 \floatingpenalty\@MM | |
8222 \leftskip\z@skip | |
8223 \rightskip\z@skip | |
8224 \spaceskip\z@skip | |
8225 \xspaceskip\z@skip | |
8226 \parindent\defaultparindent | |
8227 % | |
8228 \smallfonts \rm | |
8229 % | |
8230 % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears | |
8231 % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use | |
8232 % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote | |
8233 % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style). | |
8234 \let\noindent = \relax | |
8235 % | |
8236 % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the | |
8237 % footnote extends for more than one paragraph. | |
8238 \everypar = {\hang}% | |
8239 \textindent{\thisfootno}% | |
8240 % | |
8241 % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this | |
8242 % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it | |
8243 % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote. | |
8244 \footstrut | |
8245 % | |
8246 % Invoke rest of plain TeX footnote routine. | |
8247 \futurelet\next\fo@t | |
8248 } | |
8249 }%end \catcode `\@=11 | |
8250 | |
8251 % In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create | |
8252 % the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion | |
8253 % would be lost. | |
8254 % Similarly, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote | |
8255 % text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished. | |
8256 % And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03. | |
8257 | |
8258 % Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro. | |
8259 % Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled | |
8260 % out prematurely. | |
8261 % | |
8262 \def\startsavinginserts{% | |
8263 \ifx \insert\ptexinsert | |
8264 \let\insert\saveinsert | |
8265 \else | |
8266 \let\checkinserts\relax | |
8267 \fi | |
8268 } | |
8269 | |
8270 % This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and | |
8271 % \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}. | |
8272 % | |
8273 \def\saveinsert#1{% | |
8274 \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}% | |
8275 \afterassignment\next | |
8276 % swallow the left brace | |
8277 \let\temp = | |
8278 } | |
8279 \def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}} | |
8280 \def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1} | |
8281 | |
8282 \def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi} | |
8283 | |
8284 \def\placesaveins#1{% | |
8285 \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname | |
8286 {\box#1}% | |
8287 } | |
8288 | |
8289 % eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other: | |
8290 { | |
8291 \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials % ;-) | |
8292 \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{} | |
8293 } | |
8294 | |
8295 % initialization: | |
8296 \def\newsaveins #1{% | |
8297 \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}% | |
8298 \next | |
8299 } | |
8300 \def\newsaveinsX #1{% | |
8301 \csname newbox\endcsname #1% | |
8302 \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts | |
8303 \checksaveins #1}% | |
8304 } | |
8305 | |
8306 % initialize: | |
8307 \let\checkinserts\empty | |
8308 \newsaveins\footins | |
8309 \newsaveins\margin | |
8310 | |
8311 | |
8312 % @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this. | |
8313 % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain. | |
8314 % | |
8315 % Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image | |
8316 % time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get | |
8317 % undone and the next image would fail. | |
8318 \openin 1 = epsf.tex | |
8319 \ifeof 1 \else | |
8320 % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in | |
8321 % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan). | |
8322 \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }% | |
8323 \input epsf.tex | |
8324 \fi | |
8325 \closein 1 | |
8326 % | |
8327 % We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex. | |
8328 \newif\ifwarnednoepsf | |
8329 \newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to | |
8330 work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get | |
8331 it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.} | |
8332 % | |
8333 \def\image#1{% | |
8334 \ifx\epsfbox\thisisundefined | |
8335 \ifwarnednoepsf \else | |
8336 \errhelp = \noepsfhelp | |
8337 \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}% | |
8338 \global\warnednoepsftrue | |
8339 \fi | |
8340 \else | |
8341 \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish | |
8342 \fi | |
8343 } | |
8344 % | |
8345 % Arguments to @image: | |
8346 % #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension. | |
8347 % #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height. | |
8348 % #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text. | |
8349 % #5 is (ignored optional) extension. | |
8350 % #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing stuff. | |
8351 \newif\ifimagevmode | |
8352 \def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup | |
8353 \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example | |
8354 \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names | |
8355 % If the image is by itself, center it. | |
8356 \ifvmode | |
8357 \imagevmodetrue | |
8358 \else \ifx\centersub\centerV | |
8359 % for @center @image, we need a vbox so we can have our vertical space | |
8360 \imagevmodetrue | |
8361 \vbox\bgroup % vbox has better behavior than vtop herev | |
8362 \fi\fi | |
8363 % | |
8364 \ifimagevmode | |
8365 \nobreak\medskip | |
8366 % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert | |
8367 % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space | |
8368 % above and below. | |
8369 \nobreak\vskip\parskip | |
8370 \nobreak | |
8371 \fi | |
8372 % | |
8373 % Leave vertical mode so that indentation from an enclosing | |
8374 % environment such as @quotation is respected. | |
8375 % However, if we're at the top level, we don't want the | |
8376 % normal paragraph indentation. | |
8377 % On the other hand, if we are in the case of @center @image, we don't | |
8378 % want to start a paragraph, which will create a hsize-width box and | |
8379 % eradicate the centering. | |
8380 \ifx\centersub\centerV\else \noindent \fi | |
8381 % | |
8382 % Output the image. | |
8383 \ifpdf | |
8384 \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}% | |
8385 \else | |
8386 % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure. | |
8387 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi | |
8388 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi | |
8389 \epsfbox{#1.eps}% | |
8390 \fi | |
8391 % | |
8392 \ifimagevmode | |
8393 \medskip % space after a standalone image | |
8394 \fi | |
8395 \ifx\centersub\centerV \egroup \fi | |
8396 \endgroup} | |
8397 | |
8398 | |
8399 % @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables, | |
8400 % etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the | |
8401 % float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future. | |
8402 % | |
8403 \envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,\finish} | |
8404 | |
8405 % There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it. | |
8406 \def\eatcommaspace#1, {#1,} | |
8407 | |
8408 % #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically | |
8409 % "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted, | |
8410 % this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to. | |
8411 % | |
8412 % #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to | |
8413 % be referable. | |
8414 % | |
8415 % #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It | |
8416 % will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom). | |
8417 % | |
8418 % We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each | |
8419 % chapter-level command. | |
8420 \let\resetallfloatnos=\empty | |
8421 % | |
8422 \def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{% | |
8423 \let\thiscaption=\empty | |
8424 \let\thisshortcaption=\empty | |
8425 % | |
8426 % don't lose footnotes inside @float. | |
8427 % | |
8428 % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an | |
8429 % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04 | |
8430 % | |
8431 \startsavinginserts | |
8432 % | |
8433 % We can't be used inside a paragraph. | |
8434 \par | |
8435 % | |
8436 \vtop\bgroup | |
8437 \def\floattype{#1}% | |
8438 \def\floatlabel{#2}% | |
8439 \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet. | |
8440 % | |
8441 \ifx\floattype\empty | |
8442 \let\safefloattype=\empty | |
8443 \else | |
8444 {% | |
8445 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters, | |
8446 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name. | |
8447 \indexnofonts | |
8448 \turnoffactive | |
8449 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}% | |
8450 }% | |
8451 \fi | |
8452 % | |
8453 % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type. | |
8454 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else | |
8455 % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1, | |
8456 % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.) | |
8457 % | |
8458 \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname | |
8459 \global\advance\floatno by 1 | |
8460 % | |
8461 {% | |
8462 % This magic value for \lastsection is output by \setref as the | |
8463 % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float | |
8464 % labels (which have a completely different output format) from | |
8465 % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the | |
8466 % lists of floats. | |
8467 % | |
8468 \edef\lastsection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}% | |
8469 \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}% | |
8470 }% | |
8471 \fi | |
8472 % | |
8473 % start with \parskip glue, I guess. | |
8474 \vskip\parskip | |
8475 % | |
8476 % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section. | |
8477 \restorefirstparagraphindent | |
8478 } | |
8479 | |
8480 % we have these possibilities: | |
8481 % @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap | |
8482 % @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1 | |
8483 % @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap | |
8484 % @float Foo & no caption: Foo | |
8485 % @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap | |
8486 % @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1 | |
8487 % @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap | |
8488 % @float & no caption: | |
8489 % | |
8490 \def\Efloat{% | |
8491 \let\floatident = \empty | |
8492 % | |
8493 % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first. | |
8494 \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi | |
8495 % | |
8496 % If we have an xref label, the number comes next. | |
8497 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else | |
8498 \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first. | |
8499 \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}% | |
8500 \fi | |
8501 % the number. | |
8502 \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}% | |
8503 \fi | |
8504 % | |
8505 % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in | |
8506 % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again. | |
8507 \let\captionline = \floatident | |
8508 % | |
8509 \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else | |
8510 \ifx\floatident\empty \else | |
8511 \appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between | |
8512 \fi | |
8513 % | |
8514 % caption text. | |
8515 \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}% | |
8516 \fi | |
8517 % | |
8518 % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before. | |
8519 % Eventually this needs to become an \insert. | |
8520 \ifx\captionline\empty \else | |
8521 \vskip.5\parskip | |
8522 \captionline | |
8523 % | |
8524 % Space below caption. | |
8525 \vskip\parskip | |
8526 \fi | |
8527 % | |
8528 % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this | |
8529 % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint. | |
8530 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else | |
8531 % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as | |
8532 % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short | |
8533 % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing. | |
8534 {% | |
8535 \atdummies | |
8536 % | |
8537 % since we read the caption text in the macro world, where ^^M | |
8538 % is turned into a normal character, we have to scan it back, so | |
8539 % we don't write the literal three characters "^^M" into the aux file. | |
8540 \scanexp{% | |
8541 \xdef\noexpand\gtemp{% | |
8542 \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty | |
8543 \thiscaption | |
8544 \else | |
8545 \thisshortcaption | |
8546 \fi | |
8547 }% | |
8548 }% | |
8549 \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{\floatident | |
8550 \ifx\gtemp\empty \else : \gtemp \fi}}% | |
8551 }% | |
8552 \fi | |
8553 \egroup % end of \vtop | |
8554 % | |
8555 % place the captured inserts | |
8556 % | |
8557 % BEWARE: when the floats start floating, we have to issue warning | |
8558 % whenever an insert appears inside a float which could possibly | |
8559 % float. --kasal, 26may04 | |
8560 % | |
8561 \checkinserts | |
8562 } | |
8563 | |
8564 % Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either. | |
8565 % | |
8566 \def\appendtomacro#1#2{% | |
8567 \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}% | |
8568 } | |
8569 | |
8570 % @caption, @shortcaption | |
8571 % | |
8572 \def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption} | |
8573 \def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption} | |
8574 \def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption} | |
8575 \def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}} | |
8576 | |
8577 % The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are | |
8578 % going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno. | |
8579 \def\getfloatno#1{% | |
8580 \ifx#1\relax | |
8581 % Haven't seen this figure type before. | |
8582 \csname newcount\endcsname #1% | |
8583 % | |
8584 % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap. | |
8585 \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos | |
8586 \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }% | |
8587 \fi | |
8588 \let\floatno#1% | |
8589 } | |
8590 | |
8591 % \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref | |
8592 % to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we | |
8593 % first read the @float command. | |
8594 % | |
8595 \def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}% | |
8596 | |
8597 % Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can | |
8598 % distinguish floats from other xref types. | |
8599 \def\floatmagic{!!float!!} | |
8600 | |
8601 % #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional | |
8602 % which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic | |
8603 % \lastsection value which we \setref above. | |
8604 % | |
8605 \def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish} | |
8606 % | |
8607 % #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the | |
8608 % (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2. | |
8609 % | |
8610 \def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{% | |
8611 \def\temp{#1}% | |
8612 \def\iffloattype{#2}% | |
8613 \ifx\temp\floatmagic | |
8614 } | |
8615 | |
8616 % @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents. | |
8617 % | |
8618 \parseargdef\listoffloats{% | |
8619 \def\floattype{#1}% floattype | |
8620 {% | |
8621 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters, | |
8622 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name. | |
8623 \indexnofonts | |
8624 \turnoffactive | |
8625 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}% | |
8626 }% | |
8627 % | |
8628 % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE. | |
8629 \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax | |
8630 \ifhavexrefs | |
8631 % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo. | |
8632 \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}% | |
8633 \fi | |
8634 \else | |
8635 \begingroup | |
8636 \leftskip=\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc | |
8637 \let\do=\listoffloatsdo | |
8638 \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname | |
8639 \endgroup | |
8640 \fi | |
8641 } | |
8642 | |
8643 % This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the | |
8644 % xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the | |
8645 % aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which | |
8646 % has the text we're supposed to typeset here. | |
8647 % | |
8648 % Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since | |
8649 % they won't appear in the aux file). | |
8650 % | |
8651 \def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish} | |
8652 \def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{% | |
8653 % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just | |
8654 % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the | |
8655 % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link | |
8656 % in pdf output. | |
8657 \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}% | |
8658 % | |
8659 % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index. | |
8660 \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}% | |
8661 \writeentry | |
8662 }} | |
8663 | |
8664 | |
8665 \message{localization,} | |
8666 | |
8667 % For single-language documents, @documentlanguage is usually given very | |
8668 % early, just after @documentencoding. Single argument is the language | |
8669 % (de) or locale (de_DE) abbreviation. | |
8670 % | |
8671 { | |
8672 \catcode`\_ = \active | |
8673 \globaldefs=1 | |
8674 \parseargdef\documentlanguage{\begingroup | |
8675 \let_=\normalunderscore % normal _ character for filenames | |
8676 \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX. | |
8677 % Read the file by the name they passed if it exists. | |
8678 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex | |
8679 \ifeof 1 | |
8680 \documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore{#1_\finish}% | |
8681 \else | |
8682 \globaldefs = 1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist | |
8683 \input txi-#1.tex | |
8684 \fi | |
8685 \closein 1 | |
8686 \endgroup % end raw TeX | |
8687 \endgroup} | |
8688 % | |
8689 % If they passed de_DE, and txi-de_DE.tex doesn't exist, | |
8690 % try txi-de.tex. | |
8691 % | |
8692 \gdef\documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore#1_#2\finish{% | |
8693 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex | |
8694 \ifeof 1 | |
8695 \errhelp = \nolanghelp | |
8696 \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}% | |
8697 \else | |
8698 \globaldefs = 1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist | |
8699 \input txi-#1.tex | |
8700 \fi | |
8701 \closein 1 | |
8702 } | |
8703 }% end of special _ catcode | |
8704 % | |
8705 \newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or | |
8706 is empty. Maybe you need to install it? Putting it in the current | |
8707 directory should work if nowhere else does.} | |
8708 | |
8709 % This macro is called from txi-??.tex files; the first argument is the | |
8710 % \language name to set (without the "\lang@" prefix), the second and | |
8711 % third args are \{left,right}hyphenmin. | |
8712 % | |
8713 % The language names to pass are determined when the format is built. | |
8714 % See the etex.log file created at that time, e.g., | |
8715 % /usr/local/texlive/2008/texmf-var/web2c/pdftex/etex.log. | |
8716 % | |
8717 % With TeX Live 2008, etex now includes hyphenation patterns for all | |
8718 % available languages. This means we can support hyphenation in | |
8719 % Texinfo, at least to some extent. (This still doesn't solve the | |
8720 % accented characters problem.) | |
8721 % | |
8722 \catcode`@=11 | |
8723 \def\txisetlanguage#1#2#3{% | |
8724 % do not set the language if the name is undefined in the current TeX. | |
8725 \expandafter\ifx\csname lang@#1\endcsname \relax | |
8726 \message{no patterns for #1}% | |
8727 \else | |
8728 \global\language = \csname lang@#1\endcsname | |
8729 \fi | |
8730 % but there is no harm in adjusting the hyphenmin values regardless. | |
8731 \global\lefthyphenmin = #2\relax | |
8732 \global\righthyphenmin = #3\relax | |
8733 } | |
8734 | |
8735 % Helpers for encodings. | |
8736 % Set the catcode of characters 128 through 255 to the specified number. | |
8737 % | |
8738 \def\setnonasciicharscatcode#1{% | |
8739 \count255=128 | |
8740 \loop\ifnum\count255<256 | |
8741 \global\catcode\count255=#1\relax | |
8742 \advance\count255 by 1 | |
8743 \repeat | |
8744 } | |
8745 | |
8746 \def\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal#1{% | |
8747 \count255=128 | |
8748 \loop\ifnum\count255<256 | |
8749 \catcode\count255=#1\relax | |
8750 \advance\count255 by 1 | |
8751 \repeat | |
8752 } | |
8753 | |
8754 % @documentencoding sets the definition of non-ASCII characters | |
8755 % according to the specified encoding. | |
8756 % | |
8757 \parseargdef\documentencoding{% | |
8758 % Encoding being declared for the document. | |
8759 \def\declaredencoding{\csname #1.enc\endcsname}% | |
8760 % | |
8761 % Supported encodings: names converted to tokens in order to be able | |
8762 % to compare them with \ifx. | |
8763 \def\ascii{\csname US-ASCII.enc\endcsname}% | |
8764 \def\latnine{\csname ISO-8859-15.enc\endcsname}% | |
8765 \def\latone{\csname ISO-8859-1.enc\endcsname}% | |
8766 \def\lattwo{\csname ISO-8859-2.enc\endcsname}% | |
8767 \def\utfeight{\csname UTF-8.enc\endcsname}% | |
8768 % | |
8769 \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii | |
8770 \asciichardefs | |
8771 % | |
8772 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \lattwo | |
8773 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active | |
8774 \lattwochardefs | |
8775 % | |
8776 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone | |
8777 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active | |
8778 \latonechardefs | |
8779 % | |
8780 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latnine | |
8781 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active | |
8782 \latninechardefs | |
8783 % | |
8784 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight | |
8785 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active | |
8786 \utfeightchardefs | |
8787 % | |
8788 \else | |
8789 \message{Unknown document encoding #1, ignoring.}% | |
8790 % | |
8791 \fi % utfeight | |
8792 \fi % latnine | |
8793 \fi % latone | |
8794 \fi % lattwo | |
8795 \fi % ascii | |
8796 } | |
8797 | |
8798 % A message to be logged when using a character that isn't available | |
8799 % the default font encoding (OT1). | |
8800 % | |
8801 \def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing in OT1 encoding: #1.}} | |
8802 | |
8803 % Take account of \c (plain) vs. \, (Texinfo) difference. | |
8804 \def\cedilla#1{\ifx\c\ptexc\c{#1}\else\,{#1}\fi} | |
8805 | |
8806 % First, make active non-ASCII characters in order for them to be | |
8807 % correctly categorized when TeX reads the replacement text of | |
8808 % macros containing the character definitions. | |
8809 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active | |
8810 % | |
8811 % Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions. | |
8812 \def\latonechardefs{% | |
8813 \gdef^^a0{\tie} | |
8814 \gdef^^a1{\exclamdown} | |
8815 \gdef^^a2{\missingcharmsg{CENT SIGN}} | |
8816 \gdef^^a3{{\pounds}} | |
8817 \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}} | |
8818 \gdef^^a5{\missingcharmsg{YEN SIGN}} | |
8819 \gdef^^a6{\missingcharmsg{BROKEN BAR}} | |
8820 \gdef^^a7{\S} | |
8821 \gdef^^a8{\"{}} | |
8822 \gdef^^a9{\copyright} | |
8823 \gdef^^aa{\ordf} | |
8824 \gdef^^ab{\guillemetleft} | |
8825 \gdef^^ac{$\lnot$} | |
8826 \gdef^^ad{\-} | |
8827 \gdef^^ae{\registeredsymbol} | |
8828 \gdef^^af{\={}} | |
8829 % | |
8830 \gdef^^b0{\textdegree} | |
8831 \gdef^^b1{$\pm$} | |
8832 \gdef^^b2{$^2$} | |
8833 \gdef^^b3{$^3$} | |
8834 \gdef^^b4{\'{}} | |
8835 \gdef^^b5{$\mu$} | |
8836 \gdef^^b6{\P} | |
8837 % | |
8838 \gdef^^b7{$^.$} | |
8839 \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ } | |
8840 \gdef^^b9{$^1$} | |
8841 \gdef^^ba{\ordm} | |
8842 % | |
8843 \gdef^^bb{\guillemetright} | |
8844 \gdef^^bc{$1\over4$} | |
8845 \gdef^^bd{$1\over2$} | |
8846 \gdef^^be{$3\over4$} | |
8847 \gdef^^bf{\questiondown} | |
8848 % | |
8849 \gdef^^c0{\`A} | |
8850 \gdef^^c1{\'A} | |
8851 \gdef^^c2{\^A} | |
8852 \gdef^^c3{\~A} | |
8853 \gdef^^c4{\"A} | |
8854 \gdef^^c5{\ringaccent A} | |
8855 \gdef^^c6{\AE} | |
8856 \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C} | |
8857 \gdef^^c8{\`E} | |
8858 \gdef^^c9{\'E} | |
8859 \gdef^^ca{\^E} | |
8860 \gdef^^cb{\"E} | |
8861 \gdef^^cc{\`I} | |
8862 \gdef^^cd{\'I} | |
8863 \gdef^^ce{\^I} | |
8864 \gdef^^cf{\"I} | |
8865 % | |
8866 \gdef^^d0{\DH} | |
8867 \gdef^^d1{\~N} | |
8868 \gdef^^d2{\`O} | |
8869 \gdef^^d3{\'O} | |
8870 \gdef^^d4{\^O} | |
8871 \gdef^^d5{\~O} | |
8872 \gdef^^d6{\"O} | |
8873 \gdef^^d7{$\times$} | |
8874 \gdef^^d8{\O} | |
8875 \gdef^^d9{\`U} | |
8876 \gdef^^da{\'U} | |
8877 \gdef^^db{\^U} | |
8878 \gdef^^dc{\"U} | |
8879 \gdef^^dd{\'Y} | |
8880 \gdef^^de{\TH} | |
8881 \gdef^^df{\ss} | |
8882 % | |
8883 \gdef^^e0{\`a} | |
8884 \gdef^^e1{\'a} | |
8885 \gdef^^e2{\^a} | |
8886 \gdef^^e3{\~a} | |
8887 \gdef^^e4{\"a} | |
8888 \gdef^^e5{\ringaccent a} | |
8889 \gdef^^e6{\ae} | |
8890 \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c} | |
8891 \gdef^^e8{\`e} | |
8892 \gdef^^e9{\'e} | |
8893 \gdef^^ea{\^e} | |
8894 \gdef^^eb{\"e} | |
8895 \gdef^^ec{\`{\dotless i}} | |
8896 \gdef^^ed{\'{\dotless i}} | |
8897 \gdef^^ee{\^{\dotless i}} | |
8898 \gdef^^ef{\"{\dotless i}} | |
8899 % | |
8900 \gdef^^f0{\dh} | |
8901 \gdef^^f1{\~n} | |
8902 \gdef^^f2{\`o} | |
8903 \gdef^^f3{\'o} | |
8904 \gdef^^f4{\^o} | |
8905 \gdef^^f5{\~o} | |
8906 \gdef^^f6{\"o} | |
8907 \gdef^^f7{$\div$} | |
8908 \gdef^^f8{\o} | |
8909 \gdef^^f9{\`u} | |
8910 \gdef^^fa{\'u} | |
8911 \gdef^^fb{\^u} | |
8912 \gdef^^fc{\"u} | |
8913 \gdef^^fd{\'y} | |
8914 \gdef^^fe{\th} | |
8915 \gdef^^ff{\"y} | |
8916 } | |
8917 | |
8918 % Latin9 (ISO-8859-15) encoding character definitions. | |
8919 \def\latninechardefs{% | |
8920 % Encoding is almost identical to Latin1. | |
8921 \latonechardefs | |
8922 % | |
8923 \gdef^^a4{\euro} | |
8924 \gdef^^a6{\v S} | |
8925 \gdef^^a8{\v s} | |
8926 \gdef^^b4{\v Z} | |
8927 \gdef^^b8{\v z} | |
8928 \gdef^^bc{\OE} | |
8929 \gdef^^bd{\oe} | |
8930 \gdef^^be{\"Y} | |
8931 } | |
8932 | |
8933 % Latin2 (ISO-8859-2) character definitions. | |
8934 \def\lattwochardefs{% | |
8935 \gdef^^a0{\tie} | |
8936 \gdef^^a1{\ogonek{A}} | |
8937 \gdef^^a2{\u{}} | |
8938 \gdef^^a3{\L} | |
8939 \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}} | |
8940 \gdef^^a5{\v L} | |
8941 \gdef^^a6{\'S} | |
8942 \gdef^^a7{\S} | |
8943 \gdef^^a8{\"{}} | |
8944 \gdef^^a9{\v S} | |
8945 \gdef^^aa{\cedilla S} | |
8946 \gdef^^ab{\v T} | |
8947 \gdef^^ac{\'Z} | |
8948 \gdef^^ad{\-} | |
8949 \gdef^^ae{\v Z} | |
8950 \gdef^^af{\dotaccent Z} | |
8951 % | |
8952 \gdef^^b0{\textdegree} | |
8953 \gdef^^b1{\ogonek{a}} | |
8954 \gdef^^b2{\ogonek{ }} | |
8955 \gdef^^b3{\l} | |
8956 \gdef^^b4{\'{}} | |
8957 \gdef^^b5{\v l} | |
8958 \gdef^^b6{\'s} | |
8959 \gdef^^b7{\v{}} | |
8960 \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ } | |
8961 \gdef^^b9{\v s} | |
8962 \gdef^^ba{\cedilla s} | |
8963 \gdef^^bb{\v t} | |
8964 \gdef^^bc{\'z} | |
8965 \gdef^^bd{\H{}} | |
8966 \gdef^^be{\v z} | |
8967 \gdef^^bf{\dotaccent z} | |
8968 % | |
8969 \gdef^^c0{\'R} | |
8970 \gdef^^c1{\'A} | |
8971 \gdef^^c2{\^A} | |
8972 \gdef^^c3{\u A} | |
8973 \gdef^^c4{\"A} | |
8974 \gdef^^c5{\'L} | |
8975 \gdef^^c6{\'C} | |
8976 \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C} | |
8977 \gdef^^c8{\v C} | |
8978 \gdef^^c9{\'E} | |
8979 \gdef^^ca{\ogonek{E}} | |
8980 \gdef^^cb{\"E} | |
8981 \gdef^^cc{\v E} | |
8982 \gdef^^cd{\'I} | |
8983 \gdef^^ce{\^I} | |
8984 \gdef^^cf{\v D} | |
8985 % | |
8986 \gdef^^d0{\DH} | |
8987 \gdef^^d1{\'N} | |
8988 \gdef^^d2{\v N} | |
8989 \gdef^^d3{\'O} | |
8990 \gdef^^d4{\^O} | |
8991 \gdef^^d5{\H O} | |
8992 \gdef^^d6{\"O} | |
8993 \gdef^^d7{$\times$} | |
8994 \gdef^^d8{\v R} | |
8995 \gdef^^d9{\ringaccent U} | |
8996 \gdef^^da{\'U} | |
8997 \gdef^^db{\H U} | |
8998 \gdef^^dc{\"U} | |
8999 \gdef^^dd{\'Y} | |
9000 \gdef^^de{\cedilla T} | |
9001 \gdef^^df{\ss} | |
9002 % | |
9003 \gdef^^e0{\'r} | |
9004 \gdef^^e1{\'a} | |
9005 \gdef^^e2{\^a} | |
9006 \gdef^^e3{\u a} | |
9007 \gdef^^e4{\"a} | |
9008 \gdef^^e5{\'l} | |
9009 \gdef^^e6{\'c} | |
9010 \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c} | |
9011 \gdef^^e8{\v c} | |
9012 \gdef^^e9{\'e} | |
9013 \gdef^^ea{\ogonek{e}} | |
9014 \gdef^^eb{\"e} | |
9015 \gdef^^ec{\v e} | |
9016 \gdef^^ed{\'{\dotless{i}}} | |
9017 \gdef^^ee{\^{\dotless{i}}} | |
9018 \gdef^^ef{\v d} | |
9019 % | |
9020 \gdef^^f0{\dh} | |
9021 \gdef^^f1{\'n} | |
9022 \gdef^^f2{\v n} | |
9023 \gdef^^f3{\'o} | |
9024 \gdef^^f4{\^o} | |
9025 \gdef^^f5{\H o} | |
9026 \gdef^^f6{\"o} | |
9027 \gdef^^f7{$\div$} | |
9028 \gdef^^f8{\v r} | |
9029 \gdef^^f9{\ringaccent u} | |
9030 \gdef^^fa{\'u} | |
9031 \gdef^^fb{\H u} | |
9032 \gdef^^fc{\"u} | |
9033 \gdef^^fd{\'y} | |
9034 \gdef^^fe{\cedilla t} | |
9035 \gdef^^ff{\dotaccent{}} | |
9036 } | |
9037 | |
9038 % UTF-8 character definitions. | |
9039 % | |
9040 % This code to support UTF-8 is based on LaTeX's utf8.def, with some | |
9041 % changes for Texinfo conventions. It is included here under the GPL by | |
9042 % permission from Frank Mittelbach and the LaTeX team. | |
9043 % | |
9044 \newcount\countUTFx | |
9045 \newcount\countUTFy | |
9046 \newcount\countUTFz | |
9047 | |
9048 \gdef\UTFviiiTwoOctets#1#2{\expandafter | |
9049 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\endcsname} | |
9050 % | |
9051 \gdef\UTFviiiThreeOctets#1#2#3{\expandafter | |
9052 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname} | |
9053 % | |
9054 \gdef\UTFviiiFourOctets#1#2#3#4{\expandafter | |
9055 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname} | |
9056 | |
9057 \gdef\UTFviiiDefined#1{% | |
9058 \ifx #1\relax | |
9059 \message{\linenumber Unicode char \string #1 not defined for Texinfo}% | |
9060 \else | |
9061 \expandafter #1% | |
9062 \fi | |
9063 } | |
9064 | |
9065 \begingroup | |
9066 \catcode`\~13 | |
9067 \catcode`\"12 | |
9068 | |
9069 \def\UTFviiiLoop{% | |
9070 \global\catcode\countUTFx\active | |
9071 \uccode`\~\countUTFx | |
9072 \uppercase\expandafter{\UTFviiiTmp}% | |
9073 \advance\countUTFx by 1 | |
9074 \ifnum\countUTFx < \countUTFy | |
9075 \expandafter\UTFviiiLoop | |
9076 \fi} | |
9077 | |
9078 \countUTFx = "C2 | |
9079 \countUTFy = "E0 | |
9080 \def\UTFviiiTmp{% | |
9081 \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiTwoOctets\string~}} | |
9082 \UTFviiiLoop | |
9083 | |
9084 \countUTFx = "E0 | |
9085 \countUTFy = "F0 | |
9086 \def\UTFviiiTmp{% | |
9087 \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiThreeOctets\string~}} | |
9088 \UTFviiiLoop | |
9089 | |
9090 \countUTFx = "F0 | |
9091 \countUTFy = "F4 | |
9092 \def\UTFviiiTmp{% | |
9093 \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiFourOctets\string~}} | |
9094 \UTFviiiLoop | |
9095 \endgroup | |
9096 | |
9097 \begingroup | |
9098 \catcode`\"=12 | |
9099 \catcode`\<=12 | |
9100 \catcode`\.=12 | |
9101 \catcode`\,=12 | |
9102 \catcode`\;=12 | |
9103 \catcode`\!=12 | |
9104 \catcode`\~=13 | |
9105 | |
9106 \gdef\DeclareUnicodeCharacter#1#2{% | |
9107 \countUTFz = "#1\relax | |
9108 %\wlog{\space\space defining Unicode char U+#1 (decimal \the\countUTFz)}% | |
9109 \begingroup | |
9110 \parseXMLCharref | |
9111 \def\UTFviiiTwoOctets##1##2{% | |
9112 \csname u8:##1\string ##2\endcsname}% | |
9113 \def\UTFviiiThreeOctets##1##2##3{% | |
9114 \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\endcsname}% | |
9115 \def\UTFviiiFourOctets##1##2##3##4{% | |
9116 \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\string ##4\endcsname}% | |
9117 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter | |
9118 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter | |
9119 \gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2}% | |
9120 \endgroup} | |
9121 | |
9122 \gdef\parseXMLCharref{% | |
9123 \ifnum\countUTFz < "A0\relax | |
9124 \errhelp = \EMsimple | |
9125 \errmessage{Cannot define Unicode char value < 00A0}% | |
9126 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "800\relax | |
9127 \parseUTFviiiA,% | |
9128 \parseUTFviiiB C\UTFviiiTwoOctets.,% | |
9129 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "10000\relax | |
9130 \parseUTFviiiA;% | |
9131 \parseUTFviiiA,% | |
9132 \parseUTFviiiB E\UTFviiiThreeOctets.{,;}% | |
9133 \else | |
9134 \parseUTFviiiA;% | |
9135 \parseUTFviiiA,% | |
9136 \parseUTFviiiA!% | |
9137 \parseUTFviiiB F\UTFviiiFourOctets.{!,;}% | |
9138 \fi\fi\fi | |
9139 } | |
9140 | |
9141 \gdef\parseUTFviiiA#1{% | |
9142 \countUTFx = \countUTFz | |
9143 \divide\countUTFz by 64 | |
9144 \countUTFy = \countUTFz | |
9145 \multiply\countUTFz by 64 | |
9146 \advance\countUTFx by -\countUTFz | |
9147 \advance\countUTFx by 128 | |
9148 \uccode `#1\countUTFx | |
9149 \countUTFz = \countUTFy} | |
9150 | |
9151 \gdef\parseUTFviiiB#1#2#3#4{% | |
9152 \advance\countUTFz by "#10\relax | |
9153 \uccode `#3\countUTFz | |
9154 \uppercase{\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2#3#4}}} | |
9155 \endgroup | |
9156 | |
9157 \def\utfeightchardefs{% | |
9158 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A0}{\tie} | |
9159 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A1}{\exclamdown} | |
9160 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A3}{\pounds} | |
9161 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A8}{\"{ }} | |
9162 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A9}{\copyright} | |
9163 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AA}{\ordf} | |
9164 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AB}{\guillemetleft} | |
9165 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AD}{\-} | |
9166 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AE}{\registeredsymbol} | |
9167 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AF}{\={ }} | |
9168 | |
9169 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B0}{\ringaccent{ }} | |
9170 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B4}{\'{ }} | |
9171 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B8}{\cedilla{ }} | |
9172 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BA}{\ordm} | |
9173 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BB}{\guillemetright} | |
9174 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BF}{\questiondown} | |
9175 | |
9176 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C0}{\`A} | |
9177 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C1}{\'A} | |
9178 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C2}{\^A} | |
9179 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C3}{\~A} | |
9180 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C4}{\"A} | |
9181 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C5}{\AA} | |
9182 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C6}{\AE} | |
9183 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C7}{\cedilla{C}} | |
9184 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C8}{\`E} | |
9185 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C9}{\'E} | |
9186 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CA}{\^E} | |
9187 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CB}{\"E} | |
9188 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CC}{\`I} | |
9189 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CD}{\'I} | |
9190 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CE}{\^I} | |
9191 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CF}{\"I} | |
9192 | |
9193 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D0}{\DH} | |
9194 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D1}{\~N} | |
9195 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D2}{\`O} | |
9196 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D3}{\'O} | |
9197 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D4}{\^O} | |
9198 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D5}{\~O} | |
9199 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D6}{\"O} | |
9200 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D8}{\O} | |
9201 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D9}{\`U} | |
9202 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DA}{\'U} | |
9203 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DB}{\^U} | |
9204 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DC}{\"U} | |
9205 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DD}{\'Y} | |
9206 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DE}{\TH} | |
9207 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DF}{\ss} | |
9208 | |
9209 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E0}{\`a} | |
9210 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E1}{\'a} | |
9211 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E2}{\^a} | |
9212 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E3}{\~a} | |
9213 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E4}{\"a} | |
9214 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E5}{\aa} | |
9215 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E6}{\ae} | |
9216 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E7}{\cedilla{c}} | |
9217 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E8}{\`e} | |
9218 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E9}{\'e} | |
9219 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EA}{\^e} | |
9220 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EB}{\"e} | |
9221 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EC}{\`{\dotless{i}}} | |
9222 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00ED}{\'{\dotless{i}}} | |
9223 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EE}{\^{\dotless{i}}} | |
9224 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EF}{\"{\dotless{i}}} | |
9225 | |
9226 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F0}{\dh} | |
9227 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F1}{\~n} | |
9228 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F2}{\`o} | |
9229 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F3}{\'o} | |
9230 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F4}{\^o} | |
9231 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F5}{\~o} | |
9232 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F6}{\"o} | |
9233 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F8}{\o} | |
9234 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F9}{\`u} | |
9235 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FA}{\'u} | |
9236 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FB}{\^u} | |
9237 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FC}{\"u} | |
9238 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FD}{\'y} | |
9239 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FE}{\th} | |
9240 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FF}{\"y} | |
9241 | |
9242 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0100}{\=A} | |
9243 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0101}{\=a} | |
9244 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0102}{\u{A}} | |
9245 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0103}{\u{a}} | |
9246 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0104}{\ogonek{A}} | |
9247 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0105}{\ogonek{a}} | |
9248 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0106}{\'C} | |
9249 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0107}{\'c} | |
9250 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0108}{\^C} | |
9251 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0109}{\^c} | |
9252 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0118}{\ogonek{E}} | |
9253 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0119}{\ogonek{e}} | |
9254 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010A}{\dotaccent{C}} | |
9255 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010B}{\dotaccent{c}} | |
9256 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010C}{\v{C}} | |
9257 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010D}{\v{c}} | |
9258 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010E}{\v{D}} | |
9259 | |
9260 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0112}{\=E} | |
9261 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0113}{\=e} | |
9262 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0114}{\u{E}} | |
9263 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0115}{\u{e}} | |
9264 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0116}{\dotaccent{E}} | |
9265 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0117}{\dotaccent{e}} | |
9266 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011A}{\v{E}} | |
9267 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011B}{\v{e}} | |
9268 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011C}{\^G} | |
9269 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011D}{\^g} | |
9270 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011E}{\u{G}} | |
9271 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011F}{\u{g}} | |
9272 | |
9273 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0120}{\dotaccent{G}} | |
9274 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0121}{\dotaccent{g}} | |
9275 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0124}{\^H} | |
9276 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0125}{\^h} | |
9277 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0128}{\~I} | |
9278 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0129}{\~{\dotless{i}}} | |
9279 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012A}{\=I} | |
9280 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012B}{\={\dotless{i}}} | |
9281 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012C}{\u{I}} | |
9282 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012D}{\u{\dotless{i}}} | |
9283 | |
9284 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0130}{\dotaccent{I}} | |
9285 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0131}{\dotless{i}} | |
9286 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0132}{IJ} | |
9287 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0133}{ij} | |
9288 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0134}{\^J} | |
9289 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0135}{\^{\dotless{j}}} | |
9290 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0139}{\'L} | |
9291 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013A}{\'l} | |
9292 | |
9293 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0141}{\L} | |
9294 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0142}{\l} | |
9295 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0143}{\'N} | |
9296 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0144}{\'n} | |
9297 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0147}{\v{N}} | |
9298 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0148}{\v{n}} | |
9299 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014C}{\=O} | |
9300 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014D}{\=o} | |
9301 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014E}{\u{O}} | |
9302 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014F}{\u{o}} | |
9303 | |
9304 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0150}{\H{O}} | |
9305 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0151}{\H{o}} | |
9306 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0152}{\OE} | |
9307 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0153}{\oe} | |
9308 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0154}{\'R} | |
9309 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0155}{\'r} | |
9310 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0158}{\v{R}} | |
9311 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0159}{\v{r}} | |
9312 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015A}{\'S} | |
9313 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015B}{\'s} | |
9314 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015C}{\^S} | |
9315 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015D}{\^s} | |
9316 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015E}{\cedilla{S}} | |
9317 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015F}{\cedilla{s}} | |
9318 | |
9319 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0160}{\v{S}} | |
9320 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0161}{\v{s}} | |
9321 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{t}} | |
9322 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{T}} | |
9323 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0164}{\v{T}} | |
9324 | |
9325 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0168}{\~U} | |
9326 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0169}{\~u} | |
9327 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016A}{\=U} | |
9328 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016B}{\=u} | |
9329 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016C}{\u{U}} | |
9330 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016D}{\u{u}} | |
9331 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016E}{\ringaccent{U}} | |
9332 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016F}{\ringaccent{u}} | |
9333 | |
9334 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0170}{\H{U}} | |
9335 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0171}{\H{u}} | |
9336 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0174}{\^W} | |
9337 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0175}{\^w} | |
9338 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0176}{\^Y} | |
9339 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0177}{\^y} | |
9340 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0178}{\"Y} | |
9341 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0179}{\'Z} | |
9342 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017A}{\'z} | |
9343 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017B}{\dotaccent{Z}} | |
9344 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017C}{\dotaccent{z}} | |
9345 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017D}{\v{Z}} | |
9346 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017E}{\v{z}} | |
9347 | |
9348 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C4}{D\v{Z}} | |
9349 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C5}{D\v{z}} | |
9350 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C6}{d\v{z}} | |
9351 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C7}{LJ} | |
9352 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C8}{Lj} | |
9353 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C9}{lj} | |
9354 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CA}{NJ} | |
9355 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CB}{Nj} | |
9356 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CC}{nj} | |
9357 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CD}{\v{A}} | |
9358 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CE}{\v{a}} | |
9359 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CF}{\v{I}} | |
9360 | |
9361 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D0}{\v{\dotless{i}}} | |
9362 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D1}{\v{O}} | |
9363 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D2}{\v{o}} | |
9364 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D3}{\v{U}} | |
9365 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D4}{\v{u}} | |
9366 | |
9367 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E2}{\={\AE}} | |
9368 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E3}{\={\ae}} | |
9369 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E6}{\v{G}} | |
9370 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E7}{\v{g}} | |
9371 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E8}{\v{K}} | |
9372 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E9}{\v{k}} | |
9373 | |
9374 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F0}{\v{\dotless{j}}} | |
9375 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F1}{DZ} | |
9376 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F2}{Dz} | |
9377 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F3}{dz} | |
9378 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F4}{\'G} | |
9379 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F5}{\'g} | |
9380 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F8}{\`N} | |
9381 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F9}{\`n} | |
9382 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FC}{\'{\AE}} | |
9383 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FD}{\'{\ae}} | |
9384 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FE}{\'{\O}} | |
9385 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FF}{\'{\o}} | |
9386 | |
9387 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021E}{\v{H}} | |
9388 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021F}{\v{h}} | |
9389 | |
9390 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0226}{\dotaccent{A}} | |
9391 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0227}{\dotaccent{a}} | |
9392 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0228}{\cedilla{E}} | |
9393 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0229}{\cedilla{e}} | |
9394 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022E}{\dotaccent{O}} | |
9395 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022F}{\dotaccent{o}} | |
9396 | |
9397 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0232}{\=Y} | |
9398 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0233}{\=y} | |
9399 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0237}{\dotless{j}} | |
9400 | |
9401 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{02DB}{\ogonek{ }} | |
9402 | |
9403 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E02}{\dotaccent{B}} | |
9404 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E03}{\dotaccent{b}} | |
9405 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E04}{\udotaccent{B}} | |
9406 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E05}{\udotaccent{b}} | |
9407 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E06}{\ubaraccent{B}} | |
9408 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E07}{\ubaraccent{b}} | |
9409 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0A}{\dotaccent{D}} | |
9410 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0B}{\dotaccent{d}} | |
9411 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0C}{\udotaccent{D}} | |
9412 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0D}{\udotaccent{d}} | |
9413 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0E}{\ubaraccent{D}} | |
9414 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0F}{\ubaraccent{d}} | |
9415 | |
9416 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1E}{\dotaccent{F}} | |
9417 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1F}{\dotaccent{f}} | |
9418 | |
9419 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E20}{\=G} | |
9420 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E21}{\=g} | |
9421 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E22}{\dotaccent{H}} | |
9422 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E23}{\dotaccent{h}} | |
9423 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E24}{\udotaccent{H}} | |
9424 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E25}{\udotaccent{h}} | |
9425 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E26}{\"H} | |
9426 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E27}{\"h} | |
9427 | |
9428 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E30}{\'K} | |
9429 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E31}{\'k} | |
9430 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E32}{\udotaccent{K}} | |
9431 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E33}{\udotaccent{k}} | |
9432 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E34}{\ubaraccent{K}} | |
9433 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E35}{\ubaraccent{k}} | |
9434 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E36}{\udotaccent{L}} | |
9435 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E37}{\udotaccent{l}} | |
9436 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3A}{\ubaraccent{L}} | |
9437 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3B}{\ubaraccent{l}} | |
9438 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3E}{\'M} | |
9439 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3F}{\'m} | |
9440 | |
9441 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E40}{\dotaccent{M}} | |
9442 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E41}{\dotaccent{m}} | |
9443 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E42}{\udotaccent{M}} | |
9444 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E43}{\udotaccent{m}} | |
9445 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E44}{\dotaccent{N}} | |
9446 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E45}{\dotaccent{n}} | |
9447 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E46}{\udotaccent{N}} | |
9448 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E47}{\udotaccent{n}} | |
9449 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E48}{\ubaraccent{N}} | |
9450 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E49}{\ubaraccent{n}} | |
9451 | |
9452 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E54}{\'P} | |
9453 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E55}{\'p} | |
9454 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E56}{\dotaccent{P}} | |
9455 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E57}{\dotaccent{p}} | |
9456 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E58}{\dotaccent{R}} | |
9457 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E59}{\dotaccent{r}} | |
9458 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5A}{\udotaccent{R}} | |
9459 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5B}{\udotaccent{r}} | |
9460 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5E}{\ubaraccent{R}} | |
9461 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5F}{\ubaraccent{r}} | |
9462 | |
9463 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E60}{\dotaccent{S}} | |
9464 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E61}{\dotaccent{s}} | |
9465 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E62}{\udotaccent{S}} | |
9466 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E63}{\udotaccent{s}} | |
9467 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6A}{\dotaccent{T}} | |
9468 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6B}{\dotaccent{t}} | |
9469 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6C}{\udotaccent{T}} | |
9470 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6D}{\udotaccent{t}} | |
9471 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6E}{\ubaraccent{T}} | |
9472 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6F}{\ubaraccent{t}} | |
9473 | |
9474 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7C}{\~V} | |
9475 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7D}{\~v} | |
9476 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7E}{\udotaccent{V}} | |
9477 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7F}{\udotaccent{v}} | |
9478 | |
9479 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E80}{\`W} | |
9480 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E81}{\`w} | |
9481 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E82}{\'W} | |
9482 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E83}{\'w} | |
9483 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E84}{\"W} | |
9484 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E85}{\"w} | |
9485 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E86}{\dotaccent{W}} | |
9486 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E87}{\dotaccent{w}} | |
9487 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E88}{\udotaccent{W}} | |
9488 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E89}{\udotaccent{w}} | |
9489 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8A}{\dotaccent{X}} | |
9490 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8B}{\dotaccent{x}} | |
9491 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8C}{\"X} | |
9492 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8D}{\"x} | |
9493 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8E}{\dotaccent{Y}} | |
9494 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8F}{\dotaccent{y}} | |
9495 | |
9496 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E90}{\^Z} | |
9497 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E91}{\^z} | |
9498 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E92}{\udotaccent{Z}} | |
9499 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E93}{\udotaccent{z}} | |
9500 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E94}{\ubaraccent{Z}} | |
9501 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E95}{\ubaraccent{z}} | |
9502 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E96}{\ubaraccent{h}} | |
9503 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E97}{\"t} | |
9504 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E98}{\ringaccent{w}} | |
9505 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E99}{\ringaccent{y}} | |
9506 | |
9507 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA0}{\udotaccent{A}} | |
9508 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA1}{\udotaccent{a}} | |
9509 | |
9510 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB8}{\udotaccent{E}} | |
9511 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB9}{\udotaccent{e}} | |
9512 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBC}{\~E} | |
9513 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBD}{\~e} | |
9514 | |
9515 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECA}{\udotaccent{I}} | |
9516 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECB}{\udotaccent{i}} | |
9517 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECC}{\udotaccent{O}} | |
9518 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECD}{\udotaccent{o}} | |
9519 | |
9520 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE4}{\udotaccent{U}} | |
9521 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE5}{\udotaccent{u}} | |
9522 | |
9523 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF2}{\`Y} | |
9524 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF3}{\`y} | |
9525 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF4}{\udotaccent{Y}} | |
9526 | |
9527 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF8}{\~Y} | |
9528 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF9}{\~y} | |
9529 | |
9530 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2013}{--} | |
9531 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2014}{---} | |
9532 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2018}{\quoteleft} | |
9533 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2019}{\quoteright} | |
9534 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201A}{\quotesinglbase} | |
9535 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201C}{\quotedblleft} | |
9536 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201D}{\quotedblright} | |
9537 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201E}{\quotedblbase} | |
9538 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2022}{\bullet} | |
9539 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2026}{\dots} | |
9540 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2039}{\guilsinglleft} | |
9541 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{203A}{\guilsinglright} | |
9542 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{20AC}{\euro} | |
9543 | |
9544 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2192}{\expansion} | |
9545 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D2}{\result} | |
9546 | |
9547 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2212}{\minus} | |
9548 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\point} | |
9549 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2261}{\equiv} | |
9550 }% end of \utfeightchardefs | |
9551 | |
9552 | |
9553 % US-ASCII character definitions. | |
9554 \def\asciichardefs{% nothing need be done | |
9555 \relax | |
9556 } | |
9557 | |
9558 % Make non-ASCII characters printable again for compatibility with | |
9559 % existing Texinfo documents that may use them, even without declaring a | |
9560 % document encoding. | |
9561 % | |
9562 \setnonasciicharscatcode \other | |
9563 | |
9564 | |
9565 \message{formatting,} | |
9566 | |
9567 \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt | |
9568 | |
9569 \chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt | |
9570 \secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt | |
9571 \subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt | |
9572 | |
9573 % Prevent underfull vbox error messages. | |
9574 \vbadness = 10000 | |
9575 | |
9576 % Don't be very finicky about underfull hboxes, either. | |
9577 \hbadness = 6666 | |
9578 | |
9579 % Following George Bush, get rid of widows and orphans. | |
9580 \widowpenalty=10000 | |
9581 \clubpenalty=10000 | |
9582 | |
9583 % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're | |
9584 % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of | |
9585 % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on | |
9586 % \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set. | |
9587 % | |
9588 \def\setemergencystretch{% | |
9589 \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined | |
9590 % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway. | |
9591 \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}% | |
9592 \else | |
9593 \emergencystretch = .15\hsize | |
9594 \fi | |
9595 } | |
9596 | |
9597 % Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth; | |
9598 % 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip; | |
9599 % 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width. | |
9600 % | |
9601 % We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define | |
9602 % \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip. | |
9603 % | |
9604 \def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{% | |
9605 \voffset = #3\relax | |
9606 \topskip = #6\relax | |
9607 \splittopskip = \topskip | |
9608 % | |
9609 \vsize = #1\relax | |
9610 \advance\vsize by \topskip | |
9611 \outervsize = \vsize | |
9612 \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin | |
9613 \pageheight = \vsize | |
9614 % | |
9615 \hsize = #2\relax | |
9616 \outerhsize = \hsize | |
9617 \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in | |
9618 \pagewidth = \hsize | |
9619 % | |
9620 \normaloffset = #4\relax | |
9621 \bindingoffset = #5\relax | |
9622 % | |
9623 \ifpdf | |
9624 \pdfpageheight #7\relax | |
9625 \pdfpagewidth #8\relax | |
9626 % if we don't reset these, they will remain at "1 true in" of | |
9627 % whatever layout pdftex was dumped with. | |
9628 \pdfhorigin = 1 true in | |
9629 \pdfvorigin = 1 true in | |
9630 \fi | |
9631 % | |
9632 \setleading{\textleading} | |
9633 % | |
9634 \parindent = \defaultparindent | |
9635 \setemergencystretch | |
9636 } | |
9637 | |
9638 % @letterpaper (the default). | |
9639 \def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1 | |
9640 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt | |
9641 \textleading = 13.2pt | |
9642 % | |
9643 % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even. | |
9644 \internalpagesizes{607.2pt}{6in}% that's 46 lines | |
9645 {\voffset}{.25in}% | |
9646 {\bindingoffset}{36pt}% | |
9647 {11in}{8.5in}% | |
9648 }} | |
9649 | |
9650 % Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size. | |
9651 \def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1 | |
9652 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt | |
9653 \textleading = 12pt | |
9654 % | |
9655 \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}% | |
9656 {-.2in}{0in}% | |
9657 {\bindingoffset}{16pt}% | |
9658 {9.25in}{7in}% | |
9659 % | |
9660 \lispnarrowing = 0.3in | |
9661 \tolerance = 700 | |
9662 \hfuzz = 1pt | |
9663 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt | |
9664 \defbodyindent = .5cm | |
9665 }} | |
9666 | |
9667 % Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size. | |
9668 % (Just testing, parameters still in flux.) | |
9669 \def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs = 1 | |
9670 \parskip = 1.5pt plus 1pt | |
9671 \textleading = 12pt | |
9672 % | |
9673 \internalpagesizes{7.4in}{4.8in}% | |
9674 {-.2in}{-.4in}% | |
9675 {0pt}{14pt}% | |
9676 {9in}{6in}% | |
9677 % | |
9678 \lispnarrowing = 0.25in | |
9679 \tolerance = 700 | |
9680 \hfuzz = 1pt | |
9681 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt | |
9682 \defbodyindent = .4cm | |
9683 }} | |
9684 | |
9685 % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper. | |
9686 \def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1 | |
9687 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt | |
9688 \textleading = 13.2pt | |
9689 % | |
9690 % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050 | |
9691 % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm. | |
9692 % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust | |
9693 % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then | |
9694 % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in | |
9695 % your texinfo source file like this: | |
9696 % @tex | |
9697 % \global\normaloffset = -6mm | |
9698 % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm | |
9699 % @end tex | |
9700 \internalpagesizes{673.2pt}{160mm}% that's 51 lines | |
9701 {\voffset}{\hoffset}% | |
9702 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}% | |
9703 {297mm}{210mm}% | |
9704 % | |
9705 \tolerance = 700 | |
9706 \hfuzz = 1pt | |
9707 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt | |
9708 \defbodyindent = 5mm | |
9709 }} | |
9710 | |
9711 % Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper. | |
9712 % From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000. | |
9713 % He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small. | |
9714 \def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1 | |
9715 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt | |
9716 \textleading = 12.5pt | |
9717 % | |
9718 \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}% | |
9719 {\voffset}{\hoffset}% | |
9720 {\bindingoffset}{8pt}% | |
9721 {210mm}{148mm}% | |
9722 % | |
9723 \lispnarrowing = 0.2in | |
9724 \tolerance = 800 | |
9725 \hfuzz = 1.2pt | |
9726 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt | |
9727 \defbodyindent = 2mm | |
9728 \tableindent = 12mm | |
9729 }} | |
9730 | |
9731 % A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper. | |
9732 \def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1 | |
9733 \afourpaper | |
9734 \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}% | |
9735 {\voffset}{4.6mm}% | |
9736 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}% | |
9737 {297mm}{210mm}% | |
9738 % | |
9739 % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper. | |
9740 \globaldefs = 0 | |
9741 }} | |
9742 | |
9743 % Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format. | |
9744 \def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1 | |
9745 \afourpaper | |
9746 \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}% | |
9747 {\voffset}{-2.95mm}% | |
9748 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}% | |
9749 {297mm}{210mm}% | |
9750 \globaldefs = 0 | |
9751 }} | |
9752 | |
9753 % @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH] | |
9754 % Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip, | |
9755 % and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow. | |
9756 % | |
9757 \parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish} | |
9758 \def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{% | |
9759 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi | |
9760 \globaldefs = 1 | |
9761 % | |
9762 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt | |
9763 \setleading{\textleading}% | |
9764 % | |
9765 \dimen0 = #1\relax | |
9766 \advance\dimen0 by \voffset | |
9767 % | |
9768 \dimen2 = \hsize | |
9769 \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset | |
9770 % | |
9771 \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}% | |
9772 {\voffset}{\normaloffset}% | |
9773 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}% | |
9774 {\dimen0}{\dimen2}% | |
9775 }} | |
9776 | |
9777 % Set default to letter. | |
9778 % | |
9779 \letterpaper | |
9780 | |
9781 | |
9782 \message{and turning on texinfo input format.} | |
9783 | |
9784 \def^^L{\par} % remove \outer, so ^L can appear in an @comment | |
9785 | |
9786 % DEL is a comment character, in case @c does not suffice. | |
9787 \catcode`\^^? = 14 | |
9788 | |
9789 % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text. | |
9790 \catcode`\"=\other \def\normaldoublequote{"} | |
9791 \catcode`\$=\other \def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix | |
9792 \catcode`\+=\other \def\normalplus{+} | |
9793 \catcode`\<=\other \def\normalless{<} | |
9794 \catcode`\>=\other \def\normalgreater{>} | |
9795 \catcode`\^=\other \def\normalcaret{^} | |
9796 \catcode`\_=\other \def\normalunderscore{_} | |
9797 \catcode`\|=\other \def\normalverticalbar{|} | |
9798 \catcode`\~=\other \def\normaltilde{~} | |
9799 | |
9800 % This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt | |
9801 % (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts, | |
9802 % where something hairier probably needs to be done. | |
9803 % | |
9804 % #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print | |
9805 % otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero | |
9806 % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all | |
9807 % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter. | |
9808 % | |
9809 \def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi} | |
9810 | |
9811 % Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches | |
9812 % non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from | |
9813 % italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway | |
9814 % this is not a problem. | |
9815 \def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi} | |
9816 | |
9817 % Turn off all special characters except @ | |
9818 % (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary). | |
9819 % Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can | |
9820 % use math or other variants that look better in normal text. | |
9821 | |
9822 \catcode`\"=\active | |
9823 \def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}} | |
9824 \let"=\activedoublequote | |
9825 \catcode`\~=\active | |
9826 \def~{{\tt\char126}} | |
9827 \chardef\hat=`\^ | |
9828 \catcode`\^=\active | |
9829 \def^{{\tt \hat}} | |
9830 | |
9831 \catcode`\_=\active | |
9832 \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_} | |
9833 \let\realunder=_ | |
9834 % Subroutine for the previous macro. | |
9835 \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em } | |
9836 | |
9837 \catcode`\|=\active | |
9838 \def|{{\tt\char124}} | |
9839 \chardef \less=`\< | |
9840 \catcode`\<=\active | |
9841 \def<{{\tt \less}} | |
9842 \chardef \gtr=`\> | |
9843 \catcode`\>=\active | |
9844 \def>{{\tt \gtr}} | |
9845 \catcode`\+=\active | |
9846 \def+{{\tt \char 43}} | |
9847 \catcode`\$=\active | |
9848 \def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix | |
9849 | |
9850 % If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file | |
9851 % name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line. | |
9852 % So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on. | |
9853 % \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file. | |
9854 \def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=\other \catcode`\_=\other} | |
9855 | |
9856 % Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after | |
9857 % parsing them. | |
9858 \def\turnoffactive{% | |
9859 \normalturnoffactive | |
9860 \otherbackslash | |
9861 } | |
9862 | |
9863 \catcode`\@=0 | |
9864 | |
9865 % \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font, | |
9866 % as in \char`\\. | |
9867 \global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\ | |
9868 \global\let\rawbackslashxx=\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work | |
9869 | |
9870 % \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other, and | |
9871 % \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines). | |
9872 {\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\} @gdef@doublebackslash{\\}} | |
9873 | |
9874 % In texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash | |
9875 % in fixed width font. | |
9876 \catcode`\\=\active % @ for escape char from now on. | |
9877 | |
9878 % The story here is that in math mode, the \char of \backslashcurfont | |
9879 % ends up printing the roman \ from the math symbol font (because \char | |
9880 % in math mode uses the \mathcode, and plain.tex sets | |
9881 % \mathcode`\\="026E). It seems better for @backslashchar{} to always | |
9882 % print a typewriter backslash, hence we use an explicit \mathchar, | |
9883 % which is the decimal equivalent of "715c (class 7, e.g., use \fam; | |
9884 % ignored family value; char position "5C). We can't use " for the | |
9885 % usual hex value because it has already been made active. | |
9886 @def@normalbackslash{{@tt @ifmmode @mathchar29020 @else @backslashcurfont @fi}} | |
9887 @let@backslashchar = @normalbackslash % @backslashchar{} is for user documents. | |
9888 | |
9889 % On startup, @fixbackslash assigns: | |
9890 % @let \ = @normalbackslash | |
9891 % \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont. | |
9892 % \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with | |
9893 % catcode other. We switch back and forth between these. | |
9894 @gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@backslashcurfont} | |
9895 @gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash} | |
9896 | |
9897 % Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of | |
9898 % the literal character `\'. | |
9899 % | |
9900 @def@normalturnoffactive{% | |
9901 @let"=@normaldoublequote | |
9902 @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix | |
9903 @let+=@normalplus | |
9904 @let<=@normalless | |
9905 @let>=@normalgreater | |
9906 @let\=@normalbackslash | |
9907 @let^=@normalcaret | |
9908 @let_=@normalunderscore | |
9909 @let|=@normalverticalbar | |
9910 @let~=@normaltilde | |
9911 @markupsetuplqdefault | |
9912 @markupsetuprqdefault | |
9913 @unsepspaces | |
9914 } | |
9915 | |
9916 % Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily. | |
9917 % This is canceled by @fixbackslash. | |
9918 @otherifyactive | |
9919 | |
9920 % If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up. | |
9921 % That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing | |
9922 % a backslash. | |
9923 % | |
9924 @gdef@eatinput input texinfo{@fixbackslash} | |
9925 @global@let\ = @eatinput | |
9926 | |
9927 % On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then | |
9928 % the first `\' in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix | |
9929 % that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur. | |
9930 % Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input | |
9931 % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format. | |
9932 % | |
9933 @gdef@fixbackslash{% | |
9934 @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi | |
9935 @catcode`+=@active | |
9936 @catcode`@_=@active | |
9937 } | |
9938 | |
9939 % Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages. | |
9940 @escapechar = `@@ | |
9941 | |
9942 % These (along with & and #) are made active for url-breaking, so need | |
9943 % active definitions as the normal characters. | |
9944 @def@normaldot{.} | |
9945 @def@normalquest{?} | |
9946 @def@normalslash{/} | |
9947 | |
9948 % These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special. | |
9949 % @hashchar{} gets its own user-level command, because of #line. | |
9950 @catcode`@& = @other @def@normalamp{&} | |
9951 @catcode`@# = @other @def@normalhash{#} | |
9952 @catcode`@% = @other @def@normalpercent{%} | |
9953 | |
9954 @let @hashchar = @normalhash | |
9955 | |
9956 @c Finally, make ` and ' active, so that txicodequoteundirected and | |
9957 @c txicodequotebacktick work right in, e.g., @w{@code{`foo'}}. If we | |
9958 @c don't make ` and ' active, @code will not get them as active chars. | |
9959 @c Do this last of all since we use ` in the previous @catcode assignments. | |
9960 @catcode`@'=@active | |
9961 @catcode`@`=@active | |
9962 @markupsetuplqdefault | |
9963 @markupsetuprqdefault | |
9964 | |
9965 @c Local variables: | |
9966 @c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp) | |
9967 @c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message" | |
9968 @c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{" | |
9969 @c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H" | |
9970 @c time-stamp-end: "}" | |
9971 @c End: | |
9972 | |
9973 @c vim:sw=2: | |
9974 | |
9975 @ignore | |
9976 arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-0b2efa2ea115 | |
9977 @end ignore |